]> gcc.gnu.org Git - gcc.git/blob - gcc/reload1.c
regs.h (struct reg_info_def): Add freq field.
[gcc.git] / gcc / reload1.c
1 /* Reload pseudo regs into hard regs for insns that require hard regs.
2 Copyright (C) 1987, 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998,
3 1999, 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU CC.
6
7 GNU CC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
11
12 GNU CC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU CC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
21
22 #include "config.h"
23 #include "system.h"
24
25 #include "machmode.h"
26 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
27 #include "rtl.h"
28 #include "tm_p.h"
29 #include "obstack.h"
30 #include "insn-config.h"
31 #include "flags.h"
32 #include "function.h"
33 #include "expr.h"
34 #include "regs.h"
35 #include "basic-block.h"
36 #include "reload.h"
37 #include "recog.h"
38 #include "output.h"
39 #include "cselib.h"
40 #include "real.h"
41 #include "toplev.h"
42
43 #if !defined PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY && defined STACK_BOUNDARY
44 #define PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY STACK_BOUNDARY
45 #endif
46
47 /* This file contains the reload pass of the compiler, which is
48 run after register allocation has been done. It checks that
49 each insn is valid (operands required to be in registers really
50 are in registers of the proper class) and fixes up invalid ones
51 by copying values temporarily into registers for the insns
52 that need them.
53
54 The results of register allocation are described by the vector
55 reg_renumber; the insns still contain pseudo regs, but reg_renumber
56 can be used to find which hard reg, if any, a pseudo reg is in.
57
58 The technique we always use is to free up a few hard regs that are
59 called ``reload regs'', and for each place where a pseudo reg
60 must be in a hard reg, copy it temporarily into one of the reload regs.
61
62 Reload regs are allocated locally for every instruction that needs
63 reloads. When there are pseudos which are allocated to a register that
64 has been chosen as a reload reg, such pseudos must be ``spilled''.
65 This means that they go to other hard regs, or to stack slots if no other
66 available hard regs can be found. Spilling can invalidate more
67 insns, requiring additional need for reloads, so we must keep checking
68 until the process stabilizes.
69
70 For machines with different classes of registers, we must keep track
71 of the register class needed for each reload, and make sure that
72 we allocate enough reload registers of each class.
73
74 The file reload.c contains the code that checks one insn for
75 validity and reports the reloads that it needs. This file
76 is in charge of scanning the entire rtl code, accumulating the
77 reload needs, spilling, assigning reload registers to use for
78 fixing up each insn, and generating the new insns to copy values
79 into the reload registers. */
80
81 #ifndef REGISTER_MOVE_COST
82 #define REGISTER_MOVE_COST(m, x, y) 2
83 #endif
84
85 #ifndef LOCAL_REGNO
86 #define LOCAL_REGNO(REGNO) 0
87 #endif
88 \f
89 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains a REG rtx for the hard reg
90 into which reg N has been reloaded (perhaps for a previous insn). */
91 static rtx *reg_last_reload_reg;
92
93 /* Elt N nonzero if reg_last_reload_reg[N] has been set in this insn
94 for an output reload that stores into reg N. */
95 static char *reg_has_output_reload;
96
97 /* Indicates which hard regs are reload-registers for an output reload
98 in the current insn. */
99 static HARD_REG_SET reg_is_output_reload;
100
101 /* Element N is the constant value to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
102 or zero if pseudo reg N is not equivalent to a constant.
103 find_reloads looks at this in order to replace pseudo reg N
104 with the constant it stands for. */
105 rtx *reg_equiv_constant;
106
107 /* Element N is a memory location to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
108 prior to any register elimination (such as frame pointer to stack
109 pointer). Depending on whether or not it is a valid address, this value
110 is transferred to either reg_equiv_address or reg_equiv_mem. */
111 rtx *reg_equiv_memory_loc;
112
113 /* Element N is the address of stack slot to which pseudo reg N is equivalent.
114 This is used when the address is not valid as a memory address
115 (because its displacement is too big for the machine.) */
116 rtx *reg_equiv_address;
117
118 /* Element N is the memory slot to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
119 or zero if pseudo reg N is not equivalent to a memory slot. */
120 rtx *reg_equiv_mem;
121
122 /* Widest width in which each pseudo reg is referred to (via subreg). */
123 static unsigned int *reg_max_ref_width;
124
125 /* Element N is the list of insns that initialized reg N from its equivalent
126 constant or memory slot. */
127 static rtx *reg_equiv_init;
128
129 /* Vector to remember old contents of reg_renumber before spilling. */
130 static short *reg_old_renumber;
131
132 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains the last pseudo regno reloaded
133 into hard register N. If that pseudo reg occupied more than one register,
134 reg_reloaded_contents points to that pseudo for each spill register in
135 use; all of these must remain set for an inheritance to occur. */
136 static int reg_reloaded_contents[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
137
138 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains the insn for which
139 hard register N was last used. Its contents are significant only
140 when reg_reloaded_valid is set for this register. */
141 static rtx reg_reloaded_insn[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
142
143 /* Indicate if reg_reloaded_insn / reg_reloaded_contents is valid */
144 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_valid;
145 /* Indicate if the register was dead at the end of the reload.
146 This is only valid if reg_reloaded_contents is set and valid. */
147 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_dead;
148
149 /* Number of spill-regs so far; number of valid elements of spill_regs. */
150 static int n_spills;
151
152 /* In parallel with spill_regs, contains REG rtx's for those regs.
153 Holds the last rtx used for any given reg, or 0 if it has never
154 been used for spilling yet. This rtx is reused, provided it has
155 the proper mode. */
156 static rtx spill_reg_rtx[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
157
158 /* In parallel with spill_regs, contains nonzero for a spill reg
159 that was stored after the last time it was used.
160 The precise value is the insn generated to do the store. */
161 static rtx spill_reg_store[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
162
163 /* This is the register that was stored with spill_reg_store. This is a
164 copy of reload_out / reload_out_reg when the value was stored; if
165 reload_out is a MEM, spill_reg_stored_to will be set to reload_out_reg. */
166 static rtx spill_reg_stored_to[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
167
168 /* This table is the inverse mapping of spill_regs:
169 indexed by hard reg number,
170 it contains the position of that reg in spill_regs,
171 or -1 for something that is not in spill_regs.
172
173 ?!? This is no longer accurate. */
174 static short spill_reg_order[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
175
176 /* This reg set indicates registers that can't be used as spill registers for
177 the currently processed insn. These are the hard registers which are live
178 during the insn, but not allocated to pseudos, as well as fixed
179 registers. */
180 static HARD_REG_SET bad_spill_regs;
181
182 /* These are the hard registers that can't be used as spill register for any
183 insn. This includes registers used for user variables and registers that
184 we can't eliminate. A register that appears in this set also can't be used
185 to retry register allocation. */
186 static HARD_REG_SET bad_spill_regs_global;
187
188 /* Describes order of use of registers for reloading
189 of spilled pseudo-registers. `n_spills' is the number of
190 elements that are actually valid; new ones are added at the end.
191
192 Both spill_regs and spill_reg_order are used on two occasions:
193 once during find_reload_regs, where they keep track of the spill registers
194 for a single insn, but also during reload_as_needed where they show all
195 the registers ever used by reload. For the latter case, the information
196 is calculated during finish_spills. */
197 static short spill_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
198
199 /* This vector of reg sets indicates, for each pseudo, which hard registers
200 may not be used for retrying global allocation because the register was
201 formerly spilled from one of them. If we allowed reallocating a pseudo to
202 a register that it was already allocated to, reload might not
203 terminate. */
204 static HARD_REG_SET *pseudo_previous_regs;
205
206 /* This vector of reg sets indicates, for each pseudo, which hard
207 registers may not be used for retrying global allocation because they
208 are used as spill registers during one of the insns in which the
209 pseudo is live. */
210 static HARD_REG_SET *pseudo_forbidden_regs;
211
212 /* All hard regs that have been used as spill registers for any insn are
213 marked in this set. */
214 static HARD_REG_SET used_spill_regs;
215
216 /* Index of last register assigned as a spill register. We allocate in
217 a round-robin fashion. */
218 static int last_spill_reg;
219
220 /* Nonzero if indirect addressing is supported on the machine; this means
221 that spilling (REG n) does not require reloading it into a register in
222 order to do (MEM (REG n)) or (MEM (PLUS (REG n) (CONST_INT c))). The
223 value indicates the level of indirect addressing supported, e.g., two
224 means that (MEM (MEM (REG n))) is also valid if (REG n) does not get
225 a hard register. */
226 static char spill_indirect_levels;
227
228 /* Nonzero if indirect addressing is supported when the innermost MEM is
229 of the form (MEM (SYMBOL_REF sym)). It is assumed that the level to
230 which these are valid is the same as spill_indirect_levels, above. */
231 char indirect_symref_ok;
232
233 /* Nonzero if an address (plus (reg frame_pointer) (reg ...)) is valid. */
234 char double_reg_address_ok;
235
236 /* Record the stack slot for each spilled hard register. */
237 static rtx spill_stack_slot[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
238
239 /* Width allocated so far for that stack slot. */
240 static unsigned int spill_stack_slot_width[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
241
242 /* Record which pseudos needed to be spilled. */
243 static regset_head spilled_pseudos;
244
245 /* Used for communication between order_regs_for_reload and count_pseudo.
246 Used to avoid counting one pseudo twice. */
247 static regset_head pseudos_counted;
248
249 /* First uid used by insns created by reload in this function.
250 Used in find_equiv_reg. */
251 int reload_first_uid;
252
253 /* Flag set by local-alloc or global-alloc if anything is live in
254 a call-clobbered reg across calls. */
255 int caller_save_needed;
256
257 /* Set to 1 while reload_as_needed is operating.
258 Required by some machines to handle any generated moves differently. */
259 int reload_in_progress = 0;
260
261 /* These arrays record the insn_code of insns that may be needed to
262 perform input and output reloads of special objects. They provide a
263 place to pass a scratch register. */
264 enum insn_code reload_in_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
265 enum insn_code reload_out_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
266
267 /* This obstack is used for allocation of rtl during register elimination.
268 The allocated storage can be freed once find_reloads has processed the
269 insn. */
270 struct obstack reload_obstack;
271
272 /* Points to the beginning of the reload_obstack. All insn_chain structures
273 are allocated first. */
274 char *reload_startobj;
275
276 /* The point after all insn_chain structures. Used to quickly deallocate
277 memory allocated in copy_reloads during calculate_needs_all_insns. */
278 char *reload_firstobj;
279
280 /* This points before all local rtl generated by register elimination.
281 Used to quickly free all memory after processing one insn. */
282 static char *reload_insn_firstobj;
283
284 #define obstack_chunk_alloc xmalloc
285 #define obstack_chunk_free free
286
287 /* List of insn_chain instructions, one for every insn that reload needs to
288 examine. */
289 struct insn_chain *reload_insn_chain;
290
291 #ifdef TREE_CODE
292 extern tree current_function_decl;
293 #else
294 extern union tree_node *current_function_decl;
295 #endif
296
297 /* List of all insns needing reloads. */
298 static struct insn_chain *insns_need_reload;
299 \f
300 /* This structure is used to record information about register eliminations.
301 Each array entry describes one possible way of eliminating a register
302 in favor of another. If there is more than one way of eliminating a
303 particular register, the most preferred should be specified first. */
304
305 struct elim_table
306 {
307 int from; /* Register number to be eliminated. */
308 int to; /* Register number used as replacement. */
309 int initial_offset; /* Initial difference between values. */
310 int can_eliminate; /* Non-zero if this elimination can be done. */
311 int can_eliminate_previous; /* Value of CAN_ELIMINATE in previous scan over
312 insns made by reload. */
313 int offset; /* Current offset between the two regs. */
314 int previous_offset; /* Offset at end of previous insn. */
315 int ref_outside_mem; /* "to" has been referenced outside a MEM. */
316 rtx from_rtx; /* REG rtx for the register to be eliminated.
317 We cannot simply compare the number since
318 we might then spuriously replace a hard
319 register corresponding to a pseudo
320 assigned to the reg to be eliminated. */
321 rtx to_rtx; /* REG rtx for the replacement. */
322 };
323
324 static struct elim_table *reg_eliminate = 0;
325
326 /* This is an intermediate structure to initialize the table. It has
327 exactly the members provided by ELIMINABLE_REGS. */
328 static struct elim_table_1
329 {
330 int from;
331 int to;
332 } reg_eliminate_1[] =
333
334 /* If a set of eliminable registers was specified, define the table from it.
335 Otherwise, default to the normal case of the frame pointer being
336 replaced by the stack pointer. */
337
338 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
339 ELIMINABLE_REGS;
340 #else
341 {{ FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}};
342 #endif
343
344 #define NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS ARRAY_SIZE (reg_eliminate_1)
345
346 /* Record the number of pending eliminations that have an offset not equal
347 to their initial offset. If non-zero, we use a new copy of each
348 replacement result in any insns encountered. */
349 int num_not_at_initial_offset;
350
351 /* Count the number of registers that we may be able to eliminate. */
352 static int num_eliminable;
353 /* And the number of registers that are equivalent to a constant that
354 can be eliminated to frame_pointer / arg_pointer + constant. */
355 static int num_eliminable_invariants;
356
357 /* For each label, we record the offset of each elimination. If we reach
358 a label by more than one path and an offset differs, we cannot do the
359 elimination. This information is indexed by the number of the label.
360 The first table is an array of flags that records whether we have yet
361 encountered a label and the second table is an array of arrays, one
362 entry in the latter array for each elimination. */
363
364 static char *offsets_known_at;
365 static int (*offsets_at)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
366
367 /* Number of labels in the current function. */
368
369 static int num_labels;
370 \f
371 static void replace_pseudos_in_call_usage PARAMS((rtx *,
372 enum machine_mode,
373 rtx));
374 static void maybe_fix_stack_asms PARAMS ((void));
375 static void copy_reloads PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *));
376 static void calculate_needs_all_insns PARAMS ((int));
377 static int find_reg PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *, int));
378 static void find_reload_regs PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *));
379 static void select_reload_regs PARAMS ((void));
380 static void delete_caller_save_insns PARAMS ((void));
381
382 static void spill_failure PARAMS ((rtx, enum reg_class));
383 static void count_spilled_pseudo PARAMS ((int, int, int));
384 static void delete_dead_insn PARAMS ((rtx));
385 static void alter_reg PARAMS ((int, int));
386 static void set_label_offsets PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, int));
387 static void check_eliminable_occurrences PARAMS ((rtx));
388 static void elimination_effects PARAMS ((rtx, enum machine_mode));
389 static int eliminate_regs_in_insn PARAMS ((rtx, int));
390 static void update_eliminable_offsets PARAMS ((void));
391 static void mark_not_eliminable PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, void *));
392 static void set_initial_elim_offsets PARAMS ((void));
393 static void verify_initial_elim_offsets PARAMS ((void));
394 static void set_initial_label_offsets PARAMS ((void));
395 static void set_offsets_for_label PARAMS ((rtx));
396 static void init_elim_table PARAMS ((void));
397 static void update_eliminables PARAMS ((HARD_REG_SET *));
398 static void spill_hard_reg PARAMS ((unsigned int, int));
399 static int finish_spills PARAMS ((int));
400 static void ior_hard_reg_set PARAMS ((HARD_REG_SET *, HARD_REG_SET *));
401 static void scan_paradoxical_subregs PARAMS ((rtx));
402 static void count_pseudo PARAMS ((int));
403 static void order_regs_for_reload PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *));
404 static void reload_as_needed PARAMS ((int));
405 static void forget_old_reloads_1 PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, void *));
406 static int reload_reg_class_lower PARAMS ((const PTR, const PTR));
407 static void mark_reload_reg_in_use PARAMS ((unsigned int, int,
408 enum reload_type,
409 enum machine_mode));
410 static void clear_reload_reg_in_use PARAMS ((unsigned int, int,
411 enum reload_type,
412 enum machine_mode));
413 static int reload_reg_free_p PARAMS ((unsigned int, int,
414 enum reload_type));
415 static int reload_reg_free_for_value_p PARAMS ((int, int, int,
416 enum reload_type,
417 rtx, rtx, int, int));
418 static int free_for_value_p PARAMS ((int, enum machine_mode, int,
419 enum reload_type, rtx, rtx,
420 int, int));
421 static int reload_reg_reaches_end_p PARAMS ((unsigned int, int,
422 enum reload_type));
423 static int allocate_reload_reg PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *, int,
424 int));
425 static int conflicts_with_override PARAMS ((rtx));
426 static void failed_reload PARAMS ((rtx, int));
427 static int set_reload_reg PARAMS ((int, int));
428 static void choose_reload_regs_init PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *, rtx *));
429 static void choose_reload_regs PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *));
430 static void merge_assigned_reloads PARAMS ((rtx));
431 static void emit_input_reload_insns PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *,
432 struct reload *, rtx, int));
433 static void emit_output_reload_insns PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *,
434 struct reload *, int));
435 static void do_input_reload PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *,
436 struct reload *, int));
437 static void do_output_reload PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *,
438 struct reload *, int));
439 static void emit_reload_insns PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *));
440 static void delete_output_reload PARAMS ((rtx, int, int));
441 static void delete_address_reloads PARAMS ((rtx, rtx));
442 static void delete_address_reloads_1 PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, rtx));
443 static rtx inc_for_reload PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, rtx, int));
444 static int constraint_accepts_reg_p PARAMS ((const char *, rtx));
445 static void reload_cse_regs_1 PARAMS ((rtx));
446 static int reload_cse_noop_set_p PARAMS ((rtx));
447 static int reload_cse_simplify_set PARAMS ((rtx, rtx));
448 static int reload_cse_simplify_operands PARAMS ((rtx));
449 static void reload_combine PARAMS ((void));
450 static void reload_combine_note_use PARAMS ((rtx *, rtx));
451 static void reload_combine_note_store PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, void *));
452 static void reload_cse_move2add PARAMS ((rtx));
453 static void move2add_note_store PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, void *));
454 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
455 static void add_auto_inc_notes PARAMS ((rtx, rtx));
456 #endif
457 static void copy_eh_notes PARAMS ((rtx, rtx));
458 static HOST_WIDE_INT sext_for_mode PARAMS ((enum machine_mode,
459 HOST_WIDE_INT));
460 static void failed_reload PARAMS ((rtx, int));
461 static int set_reload_reg PARAMS ((int, int));
462 static void reload_cse_delete_noop_set PARAMS ((rtx, rtx));
463 static void reload_cse_simplify PARAMS ((rtx));
464 extern void dump_needs PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *));
465 \f
466 /* Initialize the reload pass once per compilation. */
467
468 void
469 init_reload ()
470 {
471 register int i;
472
473 /* Often (MEM (REG n)) is still valid even if (REG n) is put on the stack.
474 Set spill_indirect_levels to the number of levels such addressing is
475 permitted, zero if it is not permitted at all. */
476
477 register rtx tem
478 = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode,
479 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
480 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode,
481 LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1),
482 GEN_INT (4)));
483 spill_indirect_levels = 0;
484
485 while (memory_address_p (QImode, tem))
486 {
487 spill_indirect_levels++;
488 tem = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, tem);
489 }
490
491 /* See if indirect addressing is valid for (MEM (SYMBOL_REF ...)). */
492
493 tem = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, "foo"));
494 indirect_symref_ok = memory_address_p (QImode, tem);
495
496 /* See if reg+reg is a valid (and offsettable) address. */
497
498 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
499 {
500 tem = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
501 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM),
502 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, i));
503
504 /* This way, we make sure that reg+reg is an offsettable address. */
505 tem = plus_constant (tem, 4);
506
507 if (memory_address_p (QImode, tem))
508 {
509 double_reg_address_ok = 1;
510 break;
511 }
512 }
513
514 /* Initialize obstack for our rtl allocation. */
515 gcc_obstack_init (&reload_obstack);
516 reload_startobj = (char *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, 0);
517
518 INIT_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
519 INIT_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
520 }
521
522 /* List of insn chains that are currently unused. */
523 static struct insn_chain *unused_insn_chains = 0;
524
525 /* Allocate an empty insn_chain structure. */
526 struct insn_chain *
527 new_insn_chain ()
528 {
529 struct insn_chain *c;
530
531 if (unused_insn_chains == 0)
532 {
533 c = (struct insn_chain *)
534 obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, sizeof (struct insn_chain));
535 INIT_REG_SET (&c->live_throughout);
536 INIT_REG_SET (&c->dead_or_set);
537 }
538 else
539 {
540 c = unused_insn_chains;
541 unused_insn_chains = c->next;
542 }
543 c->is_caller_save_insn = 0;
544 c->need_operand_change = 0;
545 c->need_reload = 0;
546 c->need_elim = 0;
547 return c;
548 }
549
550 /* Small utility function to set all regs in hard reg set TO which are
551 allocated to pseudos in regset FROM. */
552
553 void
554 compute_use_by_pseudos (to, from)
555 HARD_REG_SET *to;
556 regset from;
557 {
558 unsigned int regno;
559
560 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
561 (from, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, regno,
562 {
563 int r = reg_renumber[regno];
564 int nregs;
565
566 if (r < 0)
567 {
568 /* reload_combine uses the information from
569 BASIC_BLOCK->global_live_at_start, which might still
570 contain registers that have not actually been allocated
571 since they have an equivalence. */
572 if (! reload_completed)
573 abort ();
574 }
575 else
576 {
577 nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (r, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (regno));
578 while (nregs-- > 0)
579 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*to, r + nregs);
580 }
581 });
582 }
583
584 /* Replace all pseudos found in LOC with their corresponding
585 equivalences. */
586
587 static void
588 replace_pseudos_in_call_usage (loc, mem_mode, usage)
589 rtx *loc;
590 enum machine_mode mem_mode;
591 rtx usage;
592 {
593 rtx x = *loc;
594 enum rtx_code code;
595 const char *fmt;
596 int i, j;
597
598 if (! x)
599 return;
600
601 code = GET_CODE (x);
602 if (code == REG)
603 {
604 int regno = REGNO (x);
605
606 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
607 return;
608
609 x = eliminate_regs (x, mem_mode, usage);
610 if (x != *loc)
611 {
612 *loc = x;
613 replace_pseudos_in_call_usage (loc, mem_mode, usage);
614 return;
615 }
616
617 if (reg_equiv_constant[regno])
618 *loc = reg_equiv_constant[regno];
619 else if (reg_equiv_mem[regno])
620 *loc = reg_equiv_mem[regno];
621 else if (reg_equiv_address[regno])
622 *loc = gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (x), reg_equiv_address[regno]);
623 else if (GET_CODE (regno_reg_rtx[regno]) != REG
624 || REGNO (regno_reg_rtx[regno]) != regno)
625 *loc = regno_reg_rtx[regno];
626 else
627 abort ();
628
629 return;
630 }
631 else if (code == MEM)
632 {
633 replace_pseudos_in_call_usage (& XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x), usage);
634 return;
635 }
636
637 /* Process each of our operands recursively. */
638 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
639 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
640 if (*fmt == 'e')
641 replace_pseudos_in_call_usage (&XEXP (x, i), mem_mode, usage);
642 else if (*fmt == 'E')
643 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
644 replace_pseudos_in_call_usage (& XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode, usage);
645 }
646
647 \f
648 /* Global variables used by reload and its subroutines. */
649
650 /* Set during calculate_needs if an insn needs register elimination. */
651 static int something_needs_elimination;
652 /* Set during calculate_needs if an insn needs an operand changed. */
653 int something_needs_operands_changed;
654
655 /* Nonzero means we couldn't get enough spill regs. */
656 static int failure;
657
658 /* Main entry point for the reload pass.
659
660 FIRST is the first insn of the function being compiled.
661
662 GLOBAL nonzero means we were called from global_alloc
663 and should attempt to reallocate any pseudoregs that we
664 displace from hard regs we will use for reloads.
665 If GLOBAL is zero, we do not have enough information to do that,
666 so any pseudo reg that is spilled must go to the stack.
667
668 Return value is nonzero if reload failed
669 and we must not do any more for this function. */
670
671 int
672 reload (first, global)
673 rtx first;
674 int global;
675 {
676 register int i;
677 register rtx insn;
678 register struct elim_table *ep;
679
680 /* The two pointers used to track the true location of the memory used
681 for label offsets. */
682 char *real_known_ptr = NULL;
683 int (*real_at_ptr)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
684
685 /* Make sure even insns with volatile mem refs are recognizable. */
686 init_recog ();
687
688 failure = 0;
689
690 reload_firstobj = (char *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, 0);
691
692 /* Make sure that the last insn in the chain
693 is not something that needs reloading. */
694 emit_note (NULL, NOTE_INSN_DELETED);
695
696 /* Enable find_equiv_reg to distinguish insns made by reload. */
697 reload_first_uid = get_max_uid ();
698
699 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
700 /* Initialize the secondary memory table. */
701 clear_secondary_mem ();
702 #endif
703
704 /* We don't have a stack slot for any spill reg yet. */
705 memset ((char *) spill_stack_slot, 0, sizeof spill_stack_slot);
706 memset ((char *) spill_stack_slot_width, 0, sizeof spill_stack_slot_width);
707
708 /* Initialize the save area information for caller-save, in case some
709 are needed. */
710 init_save_areas ();
711
712 /* Compute which hard registers are now in use
713 as homes for pseudo registers.
714 This is done here rather than (eg) in global_alloc
715 because this point is reached even if not optimizing. */
716 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
717 mark_home_live (i);
718
719 /* A function that receives a nonlocal goto must save all call-saved
720 registers. */
721 if (current_function_has_nonlocal_label)
722 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
723 if (! call_used_regs[i] && ! fixed_regs[i] && ! LOCAL_REGNO (i))
724 regs_ever_live[i] = 1;
725
726 /* Find all the pseudo registers that didn't get hard regs
727 but do have known equivalent constants or memory slots.
728 These include parameters (known equivalent to parameter slots)
729 and cse'd or loop-moved constant memory addresses.
730
731 Record constant equivalents in reg_equiv_constant
732 so they will be substituted by find_reloads.
733 Record memory equivalents in reg_mem_equiv so they can
734 be substituted eventually by altering the REG-rtx's. */
735
736 reg_equiv_constant = (rtx *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (rtx));
737 reg_equiv_memory_loc = (rtx *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (rtx));
738 reg_equiv_mem = (rtx *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (rtx));
739 reg_equiv_init = (rtx *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (rtx));
740 reg_equiv_address = (rtx *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (rtx));
741 reg_max_ref_width = (unsigned int *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (int));
742 reg_old_renumber = (short *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (short));
743 memcpy (reg_old_renumber, reg_renumber, max_regno * sizeof (short));
744 pseudo_forbidden_regs
745 = (HARD_REG_SET *) xmalloc (max_regno * sizeof (HARD_REG_SET));
746 pseudo_previous_regs
747 = (HARD_REG_SET *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (HARD_REG_SET));
748
749 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs_global);
750
751 /* Look for REG_EQUIV notes; record what each pseudo is equivalent to.
752 Also find all paradoxical subregs and find largest such for each pseudo.
753 On machines with small register classes, record hard registers that
754 are used for user variables. These can never be used for spills.
755 Also look for a "constant" NOTE_INSN_SETJMP. This means that all
756 caller-saved registers must be marked live. */
757
758 num_eliminable_invariants = 0;
759 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
760 {
761 rtx set = single_set (insn);
762
763 if (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE && CONST_CALL_P (insn)
764 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_SETJMP)
765 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
766 if (! call_used_regs[i])
767 regs_ever_live[i] = 1;
768
769 if (set != 0 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == REG)
770 {
771 rtx note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUIV, NULL_RTX);
772 if (note
773 #ifdef LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P
774 && (! function_invariant_p (XEXP (note, 0))
775 || ! flag_pic
776 || LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (XEXP (note, 0)))
777 #endif
778 )
779 {
780 rtx x = XEXP (note, 0);
781 i = REGNO (SET_DEST (set));
782 if (i > LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
783 {
784 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
785 {
786 /* If the operand is a PLUS, the MEM may be shared,
787 so make sure we have an unshared copy here. */
788 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS)
789 x = copy_rtx (x);
790
791 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = x;
792 }
793 else if (function_invariant_p (x))
794 {
795 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS)
796 {
797 /* This is PLUS of frame pointer and a constant,
798 and might be shared. Unshare it. */
799 reg_equiv_constant[i] = copy_rtx (x);
800 num_eliminable_invariants++;
801 }
802 else if (x == frame_pointer_rtx
803 || x == arg_pointer_rtx)
804 {
805 reg_equiv_constant[i] = x;
806 num_eliminable_invariants++;
807 }
808 else if (LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
809 reg_equiv_constant[i] = x;
810 else
811 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i]
812 = force_const_mem (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)), x);
813 }
814 else
815 continue;
816
817 /* If this register is being made equivalent to a MEM
818 and the MEM is not SET_SRC, the equivalencing insn
819 is one with the MEM as a SET_DEST and it occurs later.
820 So don't mark this insn now. */
821 if (GET_CODE (x) != MEM
822 || rtx_equal_p (SET_SRC (set), x))
823 reg_equiv_init[i]
824 = gen_rtx_INSN_LIST (VOIDmode, insn, reg_equiv_init[i]);
825 }
826 }
827 }
828
829 /* If this insn is setting a MEM from a register equivalent to it,
830 this is the equivalencing insn. */
831 else if (set && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == MEM
832 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == REG
833 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SET_SRC (set))]
834 && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (set),
835 reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SET_SRC (set))]))
836 reg_equiv_init[REGNO (SET_SRC (set))]
837 = gen_rtx_INSN_LIST (VOIDmode, insn,
838 reg_equiv_init[REGNO (SET_SRC (set))]);
839
840 if (INSN_P (insn))
841 scan_paradoxical_subregs (PATTERN (insn));
842 }
843
844 init_elim_table ();
845
846 num_labels = max_label_num () - get_first_label_num ();
847
848 /* Allocate the tables used to store offset information at labels. */
849 /* We used to use alloca here, but the size of what it would try to
850 allocate would occasionally cause it to exceed the stack limit and
851 cause a core dump. */
852 real_known_ptr = xmalloc (num_labels);
853 real_at_ptr
854 = (int (*)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS])
855 xmalloc (num_labels * NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS * sizeof (int));
856
857 offsets_known_at = real_known_ptr - get_first_label_num ();
858 offsets_at
859 = (int (*)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]) (real_at_ptr - get_first_label_num ());
860
861 /* Alter each pseudo-reg rtx to contain its hard reg number.
862 Assign stack slots to the pseudos that lack hard regs or equivalents.
863 Do not touch virtual registers. */
864
865 for (i = LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1; i < max_regno; i++)
866 alter_reg (i, -1);
867
868 /* If we have some registers we think can be eliminated, scan all insns to
869 see if there is an insn that sets one of these registers to something
870 other than itself plus a constant. If so, the register cannot be
871 eliminated. Doing this scan here eliminates an extra pass through the
872 main reload loop in the most common case where register elimination
873 cannot be done. */
874 for (insn = first; insn && num_eliminable; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
875 if (GET_CODE (insn) == INSN || GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
876 || GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
877 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), mark_not_eliminable, NULL);
878
879 maybe_fix_stack_asms ();
880
881 insns_need_reload = 0;
882 something_needs_elimination = 0;
883
884 /* Initialize to -1, which means take the first spill register. */
885 last_spill_reg = -1;
886
887 /* Spill any hard regs that we know we can't eliminate. */
888 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs);
889 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
890 if (! ep->can_eliminate)
891 spill_hard_reg (ep->from, 1);
892
893 #if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
894 if (frame_pointer_needed)
895 spill_hard_reg (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, 1);
896 #endif
897 finish_spills (global);
898
899 /* From now on, we may need to generate moves differently. We may also
900 allow modifications of insns which cause them to not be recognized.
901 Any such modifications will be cleaned up during reload itself. */
902 reload_in_progress = 1;
903
904 /* This loop scans the entire function each go-round
905 and repeats until one repetition spills no additional hard regs. */
906 for (;;)
907 {
908 int something_changed;
909 int did_spill;
910
911 HOST_WIDE_INT starting_frame_size;
912
913 /* Round size of stack frame to stack_alignment_needed. This must be done
914 here because the stack size may be a part of the offset computation
915 for register elimination, and there might have been new stack slots
916 created in the last iteration of this loop. */
917 if (cfun->stack_alignment_needed)
918 assign_stack_local (BLKmode, 0, cfun->stack_alignment_needed);
919
920 starting_frame_size = get_frame_size ();
921
922 set_initial_elim_offsets ();
923 set_initial_label_offsets ();
924
925 /* For each pseudo register that has an equivalent location defined,
926 try to eliminate any eliminable registers (such as the frame pointer)
927 assuming initial offsets for the replacement register, which
928 is the normal case.
929
930 If the resulting location is directly addressable, substitute
931 the MEM we just got directly for the old REG.
932
933 If it is not addressable but is a constant or the sum of a hard reg
934 and constant, it is probably not addressable because the constant is
935 out of range, in that case record the address; we will generate
936 hairy code to compute the address in a register each time it is
937 needed. Similarly if it is a hard register, but one that is not
938 valid as an address register.
939
940 If the location is not addressable, but does not have one of the
941 above forms, assign a stack slot. We have to do this to avoid the
942 potential of producing lots of reloads if, e.g., a location involves
943 a pseudo that didn't get a hard register and has an equivalent memory
944 location that also involves a pseudo that didn't get a hard register.
945
946 Perhaps at some point we will improve reload_when_needed handling
947 so this problem goes away. But that's very hairy. */
948
949 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
950 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[i])
951 {
952 rtx x = eliminate_regs (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i], 0, NULL_RTX);
953
954 if (strict_memory_address_p (GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]),
955 XEXP (x, 0)))
956 reg_equiv_mem[i] = x, reg_equiv_address[i] = 0;
957 else if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 0))
958 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
959 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
960 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
961 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == REG
962 && (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))
963 < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
964 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1))))
965 reg_equiv_address[i] = XEXP (x, 0), reg_equiv_mem[i] = 0;
966 else
967 {
968 /* Make a new stack slot. Then indicate that something
969 changed so we go back and recompute offsets for
970 eliminable registers because the allocation of memory
971 below might change some offset. reg_equiv_{mem,address}
972 will be set up for this pseudo on the next pass around
973 the loop. */
974 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = 0;
975 reg_equiv_init[i] = 0;
976 alter_reg (i, -1);
977 }
978 }
979
980 if (caller_save_needed)
981 setup_save_areas ();
982
983 /* If we allocated another stack slot, redo elimination bookkeeping. */
984 if (starting_frame_size != get_frame_size ())
985 continue;
986
987 if (caller_save_needed)
988 {
989 save_call_clobbered_regs ();
990 /* That might have allocated new insn_chain structures. */
991 reload_firstobj = (char *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, 0);
992 }
993
994 calculate_needs_all_insns (global);
995
996 CLEAR_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
997 did_spill = 0;
998
999 something_changed = 0;
1000
1001 /* If we allocated any new memory locations, make another pass
1002 since it might have changed elimination offsets. */
1003 if (starting_frame_size != get_frame_size ())
1004 something_changed = 1;
1005
1006 {
1007 HARD_REG_SET to_spill;
1008 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (to_spill);
1009 update_eliminables (&to_spill);
1010 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1011 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (to_spill, i))
1012 {
1013 spill_hard_reg (i, 1);
1014 did_spill = 1;
1015
1016 /* Regardless of the state of spills, if we previously had
1017 a register that we thought we could eliminate, but no can
1018 not eliminate, we must run another pass.
1019
1020 Consider pseudos which have an entry in reg_equiv_* which
1021 reference an eliminable register. We must make another pass
1022 to update reg_equiv_* so that we do not substitute in the
1023 old value from when we thought the elimination could be
1024 performed. */
1025 something_changed = 1;
1026 }
1027 }
1028
1029 select_reload_regs ();
1030 if (failure)
1031 goto failed;
1032
1033 if (insns_need_reload != 0 || did_spill)
1034 something_changed |= finish_spills (global);
1035
1036 if (! something_changed)
1037 break;
1038
1039 if (caller_save_needed)
1040 delete_caller_save_insns ();
1041
1042 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_firstobj);
1043 }
1044
1045 /* If global-alloc was run, notify it of any register eliminations we have
1046 done. */
1047 if (global)
1048 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
1049 if (ep->can_eliminate)
1050 mark_elimination (ep->from, ep->to);
1051
1052 /* If a pseudo has no hard reg, delete the insns that made the equivalence.
1053 If that insn didn't set the register (i.e., it copied the register to
1054 memory), just delete that insn instead of the equivalencing insn plus
1055 anything now dead. If we call delete_dead_insn on that insn, we may
1056 delete the insn that actually sets the register if the register dies
1057 there and that is incorrect. */
1058
1059 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
1060 {
1061 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0 && reg_equiv_init[i] != 0)
1062 {
1063 rtx list;
1064 for (list = reg_equiv_init[i]; list; list = XEXP (list, 1))
1065 {
1066 rtx equiv_insn = XEXP (list, 0);
1067 if (GET_CODE (equiv_insn) == NOTE)
1068 continue;
1069 if (reg_set_p (regno_reg_rtx[i], PATTERN (equiv_insn)))
1070 delete_dead_insn (equiv_insn);
1071 else
1072 {
1073 PUT_CODE (equiv_insn, NOTE);
1074 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (equiv_insn) = 0;
1075 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (equiv_insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
1076 }
1077 }
1078 }
1079 }
1080
1081 /* Use the reload registers where necessary
1082 by generating move instructions to move the must-be-register
1083 values into or out of the reload registers. */
1084
1085 if (insns_need_reload != 0 || something_needs_elimination
1086 || something_needs_operands_changed)
1087 {
1088 HOST_WIDE_INT old_frame_size = get_frame_size ();
1089
1090 reload_as_needed (global);
1091
1092 if (old_frame_size != get_frame_size ())
1093 abort ();
1094
1095 if (num_eliminable)
1096 verify_initial_elim_offsets ();
1097 }
1098
1099 /* If we were able to eliminate the frame pointer, show that it is no
1100 longer live at the start of any basic block. If it ls live by
1101 virtue of being in a pseudo, that pseudo will be marked live
1102 and hence the frame pointer will be known to be live via that
1103 pseudo. */
1104
1105 if (! frame_pointer_needed)
1106 for (i = 0; i < n_basic_blocks; i++)
1107 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (BASIC_BLOCK (i)->global_live_at_start,
1108 HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
1109
1110 /* Come here (with failure set nonzero) if we can't get enough spill regs
1111 and we decide not to abort about it. */
1112 failed:
1113
1114 CLEAR_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
1115 reload_in_progress = 0;
1116
1117 /* Now eliminate all pseudo regs by modifying them into
1118 their equivalent memory references.
1119 The REG-rtx's for the pseudos are modified in place,
1120 so all insns that used to refer to them now refer to memory.
1121
1122 For a reg that has a reg_equiv_address, all those insns
1123 were changed by reloading so that no insns refer to it any longer;
1124 but the DECL_RTL of a variable decl may refer to it,
1125 and if so this causes the debugging info to mention the variable. */
1126
1127 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
1128 {
1129 rtx addr = 0;
1130 int in_struct = 0;
1131 int is_scalar = 0;
1132 int is_readonly = 0;
1133
1134 if (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i])
1135 {
1136 in_struct = MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i]);
1137 is_scalar = MEM_SCALAR_P (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i]);
1138 is_readonly = RTX_UNCHANGING_P (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i]);
1139 }
1140
1141 if (reg_equiv_mem[i])
1142 addr = XEXP (reg_equiv_mem[i], 0);
1143
1144 if (reg_equiv_address[i])
1145 addr = reg_equiv_address[i];
1146
1147 if (addr)
1148 {
1149 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0)
1150 {
1151 rtx reg = regno_reg_rtx[i];
1152 PUT_CODE (reg, MEM);
1153 XEXP (reg, 0) = addr;
1154 REG_USERVAR_P (reg) = 0;
1155 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (reg) = is_readonly;
1156 MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (reg) = in_struct;
1157 MEM_SCALAR_P (reg) = is_scalar;
1158 /* We have no alias information about this newly created
1159 MEM. */
1160 MEM_ALIAS_SET (reg) = 0;
1161 }
1162 else if (reg_equiv_mem[i])
1163 XEXP (reg_equiv_mem[i], 0) = addr;
1164 }
1165 }
1166
1167 /* We must set reload_completed now since the cleanup_subreg_operands call
1168 below will re-recognize each insn and reload may have generated insns
1169 which are only valid during and after reload. */
1170 reload_completed = 1;
1171
1172 /* Make a pass over all the insns and delete all USEs which we inserted
1173 only to tag a REG_EQUAL note on them. Remove all REG_DEAD and REG_UNUSED
1174 notes. Delete all CLOBBER insns that don't refer to the return value
1175 and simplify (subreg (reg)) operands. Also remove all REG_RETVAL and
1176 REG_LIBCALL notes since they are no longer useful or accurate. Strip
1177 and regenerate REG_INC notes that may have been moved around. */
1178
1179 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
1180 if (INSN_P (insn))
1181 {
1182 rtx *pnote;
1183
1184 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
1185 replace_pseudos_in_call_usage (& CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn),
1186 VOIDmode,
1187 CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn));
1188
1189 if ((GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
1190 && find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUAL, NULL_RTX))
1191 || (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
1192 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)) != REG
1193 || ! REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)))))
1194 {
1195 PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
1196 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
1197 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
1198 continue;
1199 }
1200
1201 pnote = &REG_NOTES (insn);
1202 while (*pnote != 0)
1203 {
1204 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_DEAD
1205 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_UNUSED
1206 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_INC
1207 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_RETVAL
1208 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_LIBCALL)
1209 *pnote = XEXP (*pnote, 1);
1210 else
1211 pnote = &XEXP (*pnote, 1);
1212 }
1213
1214 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
1215 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, PATTERN (insn));
1216 #endif
1217
1218 /* And simplify (subreg (reg)) if it appears as an operand. */
1219 cleanup_subreg_operands (insn);
1220 }
1221
1222 /* If we are doing stack checking, give a warning if this function's
1223 frame size is larger than we expect. */
1224 if (flag_stack_check && ! STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN)
1225 {
1226 HOST_WIDE_INT size = get_frame_size () + STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE;
1227 static int verbose_warned = 0;
1228
1229 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1230 if (regs_ever_live[i] && ! fixed_regs[i] && call_used_regs[i])
1231 size += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1232
1233 if (size > STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE)
1234 {
1235 warning ("frame size too large for reliable stack checking");
1236 if (! verbose_warned)
1237 {
1238 warning ("try reducing the number of local variables");
1239 verbose_warned = 1;
1240 }
1241 }
1242 }
1243
1244 /* Indicate that we no longer have known memory locations or constants. */
1245 if (reg_equiv_constant)
1246 free (reg_equiv_constant);
1247 reg_equiv_constant = 0;
1248 if (reg_equiv_memory_loc)
1249 free (reg_equiv_memory_loc);
1250 reg_equiv_memory_loc = 0;
1251
1252 if (real_known_ptr)
1253 free (real_known_ptr);
1254 if (real_at_ptr)
1255 free (real_at_ptr);
1256
1257 free (reg_equiv_mem);
1258 free (reg_equiv_init);
1259 free (reg_equiv_address);
1260 free (reg_max_ref_width);
1261 free (reg_old_renumber);
1262 free (pseudo_previous_regs);
1263 free (pseudo_forbidden_regs);
1264
1265 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs);
1266 for (i = 0; i < n_spills; i++)
1267 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs, spill_regs[i]);
1268
1269 /* Free all the insn_chain structures at once. */
1270 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_startobj);
1271 unused_insn_chains = 0;
1272
1273 return failure;
1274 }
1275
1276 /* Yet another special case. Unfortunately, reg-stack forces people to
1277 write incorrect clobbers in asm statements. These clobbers must not
1278 cause the register to appear in bad_spill_regs, otherwise we'll call
1279 fatal_insn later. We clear the corresponding regnos in the live
1280 register sets to avoid this.
1281 The whole thing is rather sick, I'm afraid. */
1282
1283 static void
1284 maybe_fix_stack_asms ()
1285 {
1286 #ifdef STACK_REGS
1287 const char *constraints[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
1288 enum machine_mode operand_mode[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
1289 struct insn_chain *chain;
1290
1291 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain != 0; chain = chain->next)
1292 {
1293 int i, noperands;
1294 HARD_REG_SET clobbered, allowed;
1295 rtx pat;
1296
1297 if (! INSN_P (chain->insn)
1298 || (noperands = asm_noperands (PATTERN (chain->insn))) < 0)
1299 continue;
1300 pat = PATTERN (chain->insn);
1301 if (GET_CODE (pat) != PARALLEL)
1302 continue;
1303
1304 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (clobbered);
1305 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (allowed);
1306
1307 /* First, make a mask of all stack regs that are clobbered. */
1308 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (pat, 0); i++)
1309 {
1310 rtx t = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
1311 if (GET_CODE (t) == CLOBBER && STACK_REG_P (XEXP (t, 0)))
1312 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (clobbered, REGNO (XEXP (t, 0)));
1313 }
1314
1315 /* Get the operand values and constraints out of the insn. */
1316 decode_asm_operands (pat, recog_data.operand, recog_data.operand_loc,
1317 constraints, operand_mode);
1318
1319 /* For every operand, see what registers are allowed. */
1320 for (i = 0; i < noperands; i++)
1321 {
1322 const char *p = constraints[i];
1323 /* For every alternative, we compute the class of registers allowed
1324 for reloading in CLS, and merge its contents into the reg set
1325 ALLOWED. */
1326 int cls = (int) NO_REGS;
1327
1328 for (;;)
1329 {
1330 char c = *p++;
1331
1332 if (c == '\0' || c == ',' || c == '#')
1333 {
1334 /* End of one alternative - mark the regs in the current
1335 class, and reset the class. */
1336 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (allowed, reg_class_contents[cls]);
1337 cls = NO_REGS;
1338 if (c == '#')
1339 do {
1340 c = *p++;
1341 } while (c != '\0' && c != ',');
1342 if (c == '\0')
1343 break;
1344 continue;
1345 }
1346
1347 switch (c)
1348 {
1349 case '=': case '+': case '*': case '%': case '?': case '!':
1350 case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4': case 'm':
1351 case '<': case '>': case 'V': case 'o': case '&': case 'E':
1352 case 'F': case 's': case 'i': case 'n': case 'X': case 'I':
1353 case 'J': case 'K': case 'L': case 'M': case 'N': case 'O':
1354 case 'P':
1355 break;
1356
1357 case 'p':
1358 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls][(int) BASE_REG_CLASS];
1359 break;
1360
1361 case 'g':
1362 case 'r':
1363 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls][(int) GENERAL_REGS];
1364 break;
1365
1366 default:
1367 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls][(int) REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (c)];
1368
1369 }
1370 }
1371 }
1372 /* Those of the registers which are clobbered, but allowed by the
1373 constraints, must be usable as reload registers. So clear them
1374 out of the life information. */
1375 AND_HARD_REG_SET (allowed, clobbered);
1376 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1377 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (allowed, i))
1378 {
1379 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&chain->live_throughout, i);
1380 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&chain->dead_or_set, i);
1381 }
1382 }
1383
1384 #endif
1385 }
1386 \f
1387 /* Copy the global variables n_reloads and rld into the corresponding elts
1388 of CHAIN. */
1389 static void
1390 copy_reloads (chain)
1391 struct insn_chain *chain;
1392 {
1393 chain->n_reloads = n_reloads;
1394 chain->rld
1395 = (struct reload *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack,
1396 n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
1397 memcpy (chain->rld, rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
1398 reload_insn_firstobj = (char *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, 0);
1399 }
1400
1401 /* Walk the chain of insns, and determine for each whether it needs reloads
1402 and/or eliminations. Build the corresponding insns_need_reload list, and
1403 set something_needs_elimination as appropriate. */
1404 static void
1405 calculate_needs_all_insns (global)
1406 int global;
1407 {
1408 struct insn_chain **pprev_reload = &insns_need_reload;
1409 struct insn_chain *chain, *next = 0;
1410
1411 something_needs_elimination = 0;
1412
1413 reload_insn_firstobj = (char *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, 0);
1414 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain != 0; chain = next)
1415 {
1416 rtx insn = chain->insn;
1417
1418 next = chain->next;
1419
1420 /* Clear out the shortcuts. */
1421 chain->n_reloads = 0;
1422 chain->need_elim = 0;
1423 chain->need_reload = 0;
1424 chain->need_operand_change = 0;
1425
1426 /* If this is a label, a JUMP_INSN, or has REG_NOTES (which might
1427 include REG_LABEL), we need to see what effects this has on the
1428 known offsets at labels. */
1429
1430 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL || GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
1431 || (INSN_P (insn) && REG_NOTES (insn) != 0))
1432 set_label_offsets (insn, insn, 0);
1433
1434 if (INSN_P (insn))
1435 {
1436 rtx old_body = PATTERN (insn);
1437 int old_code = INSN_CODE (insn);
1438 rtx old_notes = REG_NOTES (insn);
1439 int did_elimination = 0;
1440 int operands_changed = 0;
1441 rtx set = single_set (insn);
1442
1443 /* Skip insns that only set an equivalence. */
1444 if (set && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == REG
1445 && reg_renumber[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))] < 0
1446 && reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))])
1447 continue;
1448
1449 /* If needed, eliminate any eliminable registers. */
1450 if (num_eliminable || num_eliminable_invariants)
1451 did_elimination = eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn, 0);
1452
1453 /* Analyze the instruction. */
1454 operands_changed = find_reloads (insn, 0, spill_indirect_levels,
1455 global, spill_reg_order);
1456
1457 /* If a no-op set needs more than one reload, this is likely
1458 to be something that needs input address reloads. We
1459 can't get rid of this cleanly later, and it is of no use
1460 anyway, so discard it now.
1461 We only do this when expensive_optimizations is enabled,
1462 since this complements reload inheritance / output
1463 reload deletion, and it can make debugging harder. */
1464 if (flag_expensive_optimizations && n_reloads > 1)
1465 {
1466 rtx set = single_set (insn);
1467 if (set
1468 && SET_SRC (set) == SET_DEST (set)
1469 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == REG
1470 && REGNO (SET_SRC (set)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1471 {
1472 PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
1473 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
1474 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
1475 /* Delete it from the reload chain */
1476 if (chain->prev)
1477 chain->prev->next = next;
1478 else
1479 reload_insn_chain = next;
1480 if (next)
1481 next->prev = chain->prev;
1482 chain->next = unused_insn_chains;
1483 unused_insn_chains = chain;
1484 continue;
1485 }
1486 }
1487 if (num_eliminable)
1488 update_eliminable_offsets ();
1489
1490 /* Remember for later shortcuts which insns had any reloads or
1491 register eliminations. */
1492 chain->need_elim = did_elimination;
1493 chain->need_reload = n_reloads > 0;
1494 chain->need_operand_change = operands_changed;
1495
1496 /* Discard any register replacements done. */
1497 if (did_elimination)
1498 {
1499 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_insn_firstobj);
1500 PATTERN (insn) = old_body;
1501 INSN_CODE (insn) = old_code;
1502 REG_NOTES (insn) = old_notes;
1503 something_needs_elimination = 1;
1504 }
1505
1506 something_needs_operands_changed |= operands_changed;
1507
1508 if (n_reloads != 0)
1509 {
1510 copy_reloads (chain);
1511 *pprev_reload = chain;
1512 pprev_reload = &chain->next_need_reload;
1513 }
1514 }
1515 }
1516 *pprev_reload = 0;
1517 }
1518 \f
1519 /* Comparison function for qsort to decide which of two reloads
1520 should be handled first. *P1 and *P2 are the reload numbers. */
1521
1522 static int
1523 reload_reg_class_lower (r1p, r2p)
1524 const PTR r1p;
1525 const PTR r2p;
1526 {
1527 register int r1 = *(const short *) r1p, r2 = *(const short *) r2p;
1528 register int t;
1529
1530 /* Consider required reloads before optional ones. */
1531 t = rld[r1].optional - rld[r2].optional;
1532 if (t != 0)
1533 return t;
1534
1535 /* Count all solitary classes before non-solitary ones. */
1536 t = ((reg_class_size[(int) rld[r2].class] == 1)
1537 - (reg_class_size[(int) rld[r1].class] == 1));
1538 if (t != 0)
1539 return t;
1540
1541 /* Aside from solitaires, consider all multi-reg groups first. */
1542 t = rld[r2].nregs - rld[r1].nregs;
1543 if (t != 0)
1544 return t;
1545
1546 /* Consider reloads in order of increasing reg-class number. */
1547 t = (int) rld[r1].class - (int) rld[r2].class;
1548 if (t != 0)
1549 return t;
1550
1551 /* If reloads are equally urgent, sort by reload number,
1552 so that the results of qsort leave nothing to chance. */
1553 return r1 - r2;
1554 }
1555 \f
1556 /* The cost of spilling each hard reg. */
1557 static int spill_cost[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1558
1559 /* When spilling multiple hard registers, we use SPILL_COST for the first
1560 spilled hard reg and SPILL_ADD_COST for subsequent regs. SPILL_ADD_COST
1561 only the first hard reg for a multi-reg pseudo. */
1562 static int spill_add_cost[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1563
1564 /* Update the spill cost arrays, considering that pseudo REG is live. */
1565
1566 static void
1567 count_pseudo (reg)
1568 int reg;
1569 {
1570 int freq = REG_FREQ (reg);
1571 int r = reg_renumber[reg];
1572 int nregs;
1573
1574 if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (&pseudos_counted, reg)
1575 || REGNO_REG_SET_P (&spilled_pseudos, reg))
1576 return;
1577
1578 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted, reg);
1579
1580 if (r < 0)
1581 abort ();
1582
1583 spill_add_cost[r] += freq;
1584
1585 nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (r, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (reg));
1586 while (nregs-- > 0)
1587 spill_cost[r + nregs] += freq;
1588 }
1589
1590 /* Calculate the SPILL_COST and SPILL_ADD_COST arrays and determine the
1591 contents of BAD_SPILL_REGS for the insn described by CHAIN. */
1592
1593 static void
1594 order_regs_for_reload (chain)
1595 struct insn_chain *chain;
1596 {
1597 int i;
1598 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos;
1599 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos2;
1600
1601 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, fixed_reg_set);
1602
1603 memset (spill_cost, 0, sizeof spill_cost);
1604 memset (spill_add_cost, 0, sizeof spill_add_cost);
1605
1606 /* Count number of uses of each hard reg by pseudo regs allocated to it
1607 and then order them by decreasing use. First exclude hard registers
1608 that are live in or across this insn. */
1609
1610 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
1611 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2, &chain->dead_or_set);
1612 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos);
1613 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos2);
1614
1615 /* Now find out which pseudos are allocated to it, and update
1616 hard_reg_n_uses. */
1617 CLEAR_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
1618
1619 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1620 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i,
1621 {
1622 count_pseudo (i);
1623 });
1624 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1625 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i,
1626 {
1627 count_pseudo (i);
1628 });
1629 CLEAR_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
1630 }
1631 \f
1632 /* Vector of reload-numbers showing the order in which the reloads should
1633 be processed. */
1634 static short reload_order[MAX_RELOADS];
1635
1636 /* This is used to keep track of the spill regs used in one insn. */
1637 static HARD_REG_SET used_spill_regs_local;
1638
1639 /* We decided to spill hard register SPILLED, which has a size of
1640 SPILLED_NREGS. Determine how pseudo REG, which is live during the insn,
1641 is affected. We will add it to SPILLED_PSEUDOS if necessary, and we will
1642 update SPILL_COST/SPILL_ADD_COST. */
1643
1644 static void
1645 count_spilled_pseudo (spilled, spilled_nregs, reg)
1646 int spilled, spilled_nregs, reg;
1647 {
1648 int r = reg_renumber[reg];
1649 int nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (r, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (reg));
1650
1651 if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (&spilled_pseudos, reg)
1652 || spilled + spilled_nregs <= r || r + nregs <= spilled)
1653 return;
1654
1655 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, reg);
1656
1657 spill_add_cost[r] -= REG_FREQ (reg);
1658 while (nregs-- > 0)
1659 spill_cost[r + nregs] -= REG_FREQ (reg);
1660 }
1661
1662 /* Find reload register to use for reload number ORDER. */
1663
1664 static int
1665 find_reg (chain, order)
1666 struct insn_chain *chain;
1667 int order;
1668 {
1669 int rnum = reload_order[order];
1670 struct reload *rl = rld + rnum;
1671 int best_cost = INT_MAX;
1672 int best_reg = -1;
1673 unsigned int i, j;
1674 int k;
1675 HARD_REG_SET not_usable;
1676 HARD_REG_SET used_by_other_reload;
1677
1678 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, bad_spill_regs);
1679 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, bad_spill_regs_global);
1680 IOR_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, reg_class_contents[rl->class]);
1681
1682 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_other_reload);
1683 for (k = 0; k < order; k++)
1684 {
1685 int other = reload_order[k];
1686
1687 if (rld[other].regno >= 0 && reloads_conflict (other, rnum))
1688 for (j = 0; j < rld[other].nregs; j++)
1689 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, rld[other].regno + j);
1690 }
1691
1692 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1693 {
1694 unsigned int regno = i;
1695
1696 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (not_usable, regno)
1697 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, regno)
1698 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rl->mode))
1699 {
1700 int this_cost = spill_cost[regno];
1701 int ok = 1;
1702 unsigned int this_nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, rl->mode);
1703
1704 for (j = 1; j < this_nregs; j++)
1705 {
1706 this_cost += spill_add_cost[regno + j];
1707 if ((TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (not_usable, regno + j))
1708 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, regno + j))
1709 ok = 0;
1710 }
1711 if (! ok)
1712 continue;
1713 if (rl->in && GET_CODE (rl->in) == REG && REGNO (rl->in) == regno)
1714 this_cost--;
1715 if (rl->out && GET_CODE (rl->out) == REG && REGNO (rl->out) == regno)
1716 this_cost--;
1717 if (this_cost < best_cost
1718 /* Among registers with equal cost, prefer caller-saved ones, or
1719 use REG_ALLOC_ORDER if it is defined. */
1720 || (this_cost == best_cost
1721 #ifdef REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1722 && (inv_reg_alloc_order[regno]
1723 < inv_reg_alloc_order[best_reg])
1724 #else
1725 && call_used_regs[regno]
1726 && ! call_used_regs[best_reg]
1727 #endif
1728 ))
1729 {
1730 best_reg = regno;
1731 best_cost = this_cost;
1732 }
1733 }
1734 }
1735 if (best_reg == -1)
1736 return 0;
1737
1738 if (rtl_dump_file)
1739 fprintf (rtl_dump_file, "Using reg %d for reload %d\n", best_reg, rnum);
1740
1741 rl->nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (best_reg, rl->mode);
1742 rl->regno = best_reg;
1743
1744 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1745 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, j,
1746 {
1747 count_spilled_pseudo (best_reg, rl->nregs, j);
1748 });
1749
1750 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1751 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, j,
1752 {
1753 count_spilled_pseudo (best_reg, rl->nregs, j);
1754 });
1755
1756 for (i = 0; i < rl->nregs; i++)
1757 {
1758 if (spill_cost[best_reg + i] != 0
1759 || spill_add_cost[best_reg + i] != 0)
1760 abort ();
1761 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs_local, best_reg + i);
1762 }
1763 return 1;
1764 }
1765
1766 /* Find more reload regs to satisfy the remaining need of an insn, which
1767 is given by CHAIN.
1768 Do it by ascending class number, since otherwise a reg
1769 might be spilled for a big class and might fail to count
1770 for a smaller class even though it belongs to that class. */
1771
1772 static void
1773 find_reload_regs (chain)
1774 struct insn_chain *chain;
1775 {
1776 int i;
1777
1778 /* In order to be certain of getting the registers we need,
1779 we must sort the reloads into order of increasing register class.
1780 Then our grabbing of reload registers will parallel the process
1781 that provided the reload registers. */
1782 for (i = 0; i < chain->n_reloads; i++)
1783 {
1784 /* Show whether this reload already has a hard reg. */
1785 if (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx)
1786 {
1787 int regno = REGNO (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx);
1788 chain->rld[i].regno = regno;
1789 chain->rld[i].nregs
1790 = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx));
1791 }
1792 else
1793 chain->rld[i].regno = -1;
1794 reload_order[i] = i;
1795 }
1796
1797 n_reloads = chain->n_reloads;
1798 memcpy (rld, chain->rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
1799
1800 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs_local);
1801
1802 if (rtl_dump_file)
1803 fprintf (rtl_dump_file, "Spilling for insn %d.\n", INSN_UID (chain->insn));
1804
1805 qsort (reload_order, n_reloads, sizeof (short), reload_reg_class_lower);
1806
1807 /* Compute the order of preference for hard registers to spill. */
1808
1809 order_regs_for_reload (chain);
1810
1811 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
1812 {
1813 int r = reload_order[i];
1814
1815 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
1816 if ((rld[r].out != 0 || rld[r].in != 0 || rld[r].secondary_p)
1817 && ! rld[r].optional
1818 && rld[r].regno == -1)
1819 if (! find_reg (chain, i))
1820 {
1821 spill_failure (chain->insn, rld[r].class);
1822 failure = 1;
1823 return;
1824 }
1825 }
1826
1827 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs_local);
1828 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs_local);
1829
1830 memcpy (chain->rld, rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
1831 }
1832
1833 static void
1834 select_reload_regs ()
1835 {
1836 struct insn_chain *chain;
1837
1838 /* Try to satisfy the needs for each insn. */
1839 for (chain = insns_need_reload; chain != 0;
1840 chain = chain->next_need_reload)
1841 find_reload_regs (chain);
1842 }
1843 \f
1844 /* Delete all insns that were inserted by emit_caller_save_insns during
1845 this iteration. */
1846 static void
1847 delete_caller_save_insns ()
1848 {
1849 struct insn_chain *c = reload_insn_chain;
1850
1851 while (c != 0)
1852 {
1853 while (c != 0 && c->is_caller_save_insn)
1854 {
1855 struct insn_chain *next = c->next;
1856 rtx insn = c->insn;
1857
1858 if (insn == BLOCK_HEAD (c->block))
1859 BLOCK_HEAD (c->block) = NEXT_INSN (insn);
1860 if (insn == BLOCK_END (c->block))
1861 BLOCK_END (c->block) = PREV_INSN (insn);
1862 if (c == reload_insn_chain)
1863 reload_insn_chain = next;
1864
1865 if (NEXT_INSN (insn) != 0)
1866 PREV_INSN (NEXT_INSN (insn)) = PREV_INSN (insn);
1867 if (PREV_INSN (insn) != 0)
1868 NEXT_INSN (PREV_INSN (insn)) = NEXT_INSN (insn);
1869
1870 if (next)
1871 next->prev = c->prev;
1872 if (c->prev)
1873 c->prev->next = next;
1874 c->next = unused_insn_chains;
1875 unused_insn_chains = c;
1876 c = next;
1877 }
1878 if (c != 0)
1879 c = c->next;
1880 }
1881 }
1882 \f
1883 /* Handle the failure to find a register to spill.
1884 INSN should be one of the insns which needed this particular spill reg. */
1885
1886 static void
1887 spill_failure (insn, class)
1888 rtx insn;
1889 enum reg_class class;
1890 {
1891 static const char *const reg_class_names[] = REG_CLASS_NAMES;
1892 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
1893 error_for_asm (insn, "Can't find a register in class `%s' while reloading `asm'.",
1894 reg_class_names[class]);
1895 else
1896 {
1897 error ("Unable to find a register to spill in class `%s'.",
1898 reg_class_names[class]);
1899 fatal_insn ("This is the insn:", insn);
1900 }
1901 }
1902 \f
1903 /* Delete an unneeded INSN and any previous insns who sole purpose is loading
1904 data that is dead in INSN. */
1905
1906 static void
1907 delete_dead_insn (insn)
1908 rtx insn;
1909 {
1910 rtx prev = prev_real_insn (insn);
1911 rtx prev_dest;
1912
1913 /* If the previous insn sets a register that dies in our insn, delete it
1914 too. */
1915 if (prev && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SET
1916 && (prev_dest = SET_DEST (PATTERN (prev)), GET_CODE (prev_dest) == REG)
1917 && reg_mentioned_p (prev_dest, PATTERN (insn))
1918 && find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, REGNO (prev_dest))
1919 && ! side_effects_p (SET_SRC (PATTERN (prev))))
1920 delete_dead_insn (prev);
1921
1922 PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
1923 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
1924 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
1925 }
1926
1927 /* Modify the home of pseudo-reg I.
1928 The new home is present in reg_renumber[I].
1929
1930 FROM_REG may be the hard reg that the pseudo-reg is being spilled from;
1931 or it may be -1, meaning there is none or it is not relevant.
1932 This is used so that all pseudos spilled from a given hard reg
1933 can share one stack slot. */
1934
1935 static void
1936 alter_reg (i, from_reg)
1937 register int i;
1938 int from_reg;
1939 {
1940 /* When outputting an inline function, this can happen
1941 for a reg that isn't actually used. */
1942 if (regno_reg_rtx[i] == 0)
1943 return;
1944
1945 /* If the reg got changed to a MEM at rtl-generation time,
1946 ignore it. */
1947 if (GET_CODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]) != REG)
1948 return;
1949
1950 /* Modify the reg-rtx to contain the new hard reg
1951 number or else to contain its pseudo reg number. */
1952 REGNO (regno_reg_rtx[i])
1953 = reg_renumber[i] >= 0 ? reg_renumber[i] : i;
1954
1955 /* If we have a pseudo that is needed but has no hard reg or equivalent,
1956 allocate a stack slot for it. */
1957
1958 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0
1959 && REG_N_REFS (i) > 0
1960 && reg_equiv_constant[i] == 0
1961 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] == 0)
1962 {
1963 register rtx x;
1964 unsigned int inherent_size = PSEUDO_REGNO_BYTES (i);
1965 unsigned int total_size = MAX (inherent_size, reg_max_ref_width[i]);
1966 int adjust = 0;
1967
1968 /* Each pseudo reg has an inherent size which comes from its own mode,
1969 and a total size which provides room for paradoxical subregs
1970 which refer to the pseudo reg in wider modes.
1971
1972 We can use a slot already allocated if it provides both
1973 enough inherent space and enough total space.
1974 Otherwise, we allocate a new slot, making sure that it has no less
1975 inherent space, and no less total space, then the previous slot. */
1976 if (from_reg == -1)
1977 {
1978 /* No known place to spill from => no slot to reuse. */
1979 x = assign_stack_local (GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]), total_size,
1980 inherent_size == total_size ? 0 : -1);
1981 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
1982 /* Cancel the big-endian correction done in assign_stack_local.
1983 Get the address of the beginning of the slot.
1984 This is so we can do a big-endian correction unconditionally
1985 below. */
1986 adjust = inherent_size - total_size;
1987
1988 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (x) = RTX_UNCHANGING_P (regno_reg_rtx[i]);
1989
1990 /* Nothing can alias this slot except this pseudo. */
1991 MEM_ALIAS_SET (x) = new_alias_set ();
1992 }
1993
1994 /* Reuse a stack slot if possible. */
1995 else if (spill_stack_slot[from_reg] != 0
1996 && spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] >= total_size
1997 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]))
1998 >= inherent_size))
1999 x = spill_stack_slot[from_reg];
2000
2001 /* Allocate a bigger slot. */
2002 else
2003 {
2004 /* Compute maximum size needed, both for inherent size
2005 and for total size. */
2006 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]);
2007 rtx stack_slot;
2008
2009 if (spill_stack_slot[from_reg])
2010 {
2011 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]))
2012 > inherent_size)
2013 mode = GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]);
2014 if (spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] > total_size)
2015 total_size = spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg];
2016 }
2017
2018 /* Make a slot with that size. */
2019 x = assign_stack_local (mode, total_size,
2020 inherent_size == total_size ? 0 : -1);
2021 stack_slot = x;
2022
2023 /* All pseudos mapped to this slot can alias each other. */
2024 if (spill_stack_slot[from_reg])
2025 MEM_ALIAS_SET (x) = MEM_ALIAS_SET (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]);
2026 else
2027 MEM_ALIAS_SET (x) = new_alias_set ();
2028
2029 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
2030 {
2031 /* Cancel the big-endian correction done in assign_stack_local.
2032 Get the address of the beginning of the slot.
2033 This is so we can do a big-endian correction unconditionally
2034 below. */
2035 adjust = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - total_size;
2036 if (adjust)
2037 stack_slot = gen_rtx_MEM (mode_for_size (total_size
2038 * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2039 MODE_INT, 1),
2040 plus_constant (XEXP (x, 0), adjust));
2041 }
2042
2043 spill_stack_slot[from_reg] = stack_slot;
2044 spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] = total_size;
2045 }
2046
2047 /* On a big endian machine, the "address" of the slot
2048 is the address of the low part that fits its inherent mode. */
2049 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && inherent_size < total_size)
2050 adjust += (total_size - inherent_size);
2051
2052 /* If we have any adjustment to make, or if the stack slot is the
2053 wrong mode, make a new stack slot. */
2054 if (adjust != 0 || GET_MODE (x) != GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]))
2055 {
2056 rtx new = gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]),
2057 plus_constant (XEXP (x, 0), adjust));
2058
2059 MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (new, x);
2060 x = new;
2061 }
2062
2063 /* Save the stack slot for later. */
2064 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = x;
2065 }
2066 }
2067
2068 /* Mark the slots in regs_ever_live for the hard regs
2069 used by pseudo-reg number REGNO. */
2070
2071 void
2072 mark_home_live (regno)
2073 int regno;
2074 {
2075 register int i, lim;
2076
2077 i = reg_renumber[regno];
2078 if (i < 0)
2079 return;
2080 lim = i + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (regno));
2081 while (i < lim)
2082 regs_ever_live[i++] = 1;
2083 }
2084 \f
2085 /* This function handles the tracking of elimination offsets around branches.
2086
2087 X is a piece of RTL being scanned.
2088
2089 INSN is the insn that it came from, if any.
2090
2091 INITIAL_P is non-zero if we are to set the offset to be the initial
2092 offset and zero if we are setting the offset of the label to be the
2093 current offset. */
2094
2095 static void
2096 set_label_offsets (x, insn, initial_p)
2097 rtx x;
2098 rtx insn;
2099 int initial_p;
2100 {
2101 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2102 rtx tem;
2103 unsigned int i;
2104 struct elim_table *p;
2105
2106 switch (code)
2107 {
2108 case LABEL_REF:
2109 if (LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (x))
2110 return;
2111
2112 x = XEXP (x, 0);
2113
2114 /* ... fall through ... */
2115
2116 case CODE_LABEL:
2117 /* If we know nothing about this label, set the desired offsets. Note
2118 that this sets the offset at a label to be the offset before a label
2119 if we don't know anything about the label. This is not correct for
2120 the label after a BARRIER, but is the best guess we can make. If
2121 we guessed wrong, we will suppress an elimination that might have
2122 been possible had we been able to guess correctly. */
2123
2124 if (! offsets_known_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x)])
2125 {
2126 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
2127 offsets_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x)][i]
2128 = (initial_p ? reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset
2129 : reg_eliminate[i].offset);
2130 offsets_known_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x)] = 1;
2131 }
2132
2133 /* Otherwise, if this is the definition of a label and it is
2134 preceded by a BARRIER, set our offsets to the known offset of
2135 that label. */
2136
2137 else if (x == insn
2138 && (tem = prev_nonnote_insn (insn)) != 0
2139 && GET_CODE (tem) == BARRIER)
2140 set_offsets_for_label (insn);
2141 else
2142 /* If neither of the above cases is true, compare each offset
2143 with those previously recorded and suppress any eliminations
2144 where the offsets disagree. */
2145
2146 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
2147 if (offsets_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x)][i]
2148 != (initial_p ? reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset
2149 : reg_eliminate[i].offset))
2150 reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate = 0;
2151
2152 return;
2153
2154 case JUMP_INSN:
2155 set_label_offsets (PATTERN (insn), insn, initial_p);
2156
2157 /* ... fall through ... */
2158
2159 case INSN:
2160 case CALL_INSN:
2161 /* Any labels mentioned in REG_LABEL notes can be branched to indirectly
2162 and hence must have all eliminations at their initial offsets. */
2163 for (tem = REG_NOTES (x); tem; tem = XEXP (tem, 1))
2164 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (tem) == REG_LABEL)
2165 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, 1);
2166 return;
2167
2168 case PARALLEL:
2169 case ADDR_VEC:
2170 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2171 /* Each of the labels in the parallel or address vector must be
2172 at their initial offsets. We want the first field for PARALLEL
2173 and ADDR_VEC and the second field for ADDR_DIFF_VEC. */
2174
2175 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned) XVECLEN (x, code == ADDR_DIFF_VEC); i++)
2176 set_label_offsets (XVECEXP (x, code == ADDR_DIFF_VEC, i),
2177 insn, initial_p);
2178 return;
2179
2180 case SET:
2181 /* We only care about setting PC. If the source is not RETURN,
2182 IF_THEN_ELSE, or a label, disable any eliminations not at
2183 their initial offsets. Similarly if any arm of the IF_THEN_ELSE
2184 isn't one of those possibilities. For branches to a label,
2185 call ourselves recursively.
2186
2187 Note that this can disable elimination unnecessarily when we have
2188 a non-local goto since it will look like a non-constant jump to
2189 someplace in the current function. This isn't a significant
2190 problem since such jumps will normally be when all elimination
2191 pairs are back to their initial offsets. */
2192
2193 if (SET_DEST (x) != pc_rtx)
2194 return;
2195
2196 switch (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)))
2197 {
2198 case PC:
2199 case RETURN:
2200 return;
2201
2202 case LABEL_REF:
2203 set_label_offsets (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0), insn, initial_p);
2204 return;
2205
2206 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
2207 tem = XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1);
2208 if (GET_CODE (tem) == LABEL_REF)
2209 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, initial_p);
2210 else if (GET_CODE (tem) != PC && GET_CODE (tem) != RETURN)
2211 break;
2212
2213 tem = XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 2);
2214 if (GET_CODE (tem) == LABEL_REF)
2215 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, initial_p);
2216 else if (GET_CODE (tem) != PC && GET_CODE (tem) != RETURN)
2217 break;
2218 return;
2219
2220 default:
2221 break;
2222 }
2223
2224 /* If we reach here, all eliminations must be at their initial
2225 offset because we are doing a jump to a variable address. */
2226 for (p = reg_eliminate; p < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; p++)
2227 if (p->offset != p->initial_offset)
2228 p->can_eliminate = 0;
2229 break;
2230
2231 default:
2232 break;
2233 }
2234 }
2235 \f
2236 /* Scan X and replace any eliminable registers (such as fp) with a
2237 replacement (such as sp), plus an offset.
2238
2239 MEM_MODE is the mode of an enclosing MEM. We need this to know how
2240 much to adjust a register for, e.g., PRE_DEC. Also, if we are inside a
2241 MEM, we are allowed to replace a sum of a register and the constant zero
2242 with the register, which we cannot do outside a MEM. In addition, we need
2243 to record the fact that a register is referenced outside a MEM.
2244
2245 If INSN is an insn, it is the insn containing X. If we replace a REG
2246 in a SET_DEST with an equivalent MEM and INSN is non-zero, write a
2247 CLOBBER of the pseudo after INSN so find_equiv_regs will know that
2248 the REG is being modified.
2249
2250 Alternatively, INSN may be a note (an EXPR_LIST or INSN_LIST).
2251 That's used when we eliminate in expressions stored in notes.
2252 This means, do not set ref_outside_mem even if the reference
2253 is outside of MEMs.
2254
2255 REG_EQUIV_MEM and REG_EQUIV_ADDRESS contain address that have had
2256 replacements done assuming all offsets are at their initial values. If
2257 they are not, or if REG_EQUIV_ADDRESS is nonzero for a pseudo we
2258 encounter, return the actual location so that find_reloads will do
2259 the proper thing. */
2260
2261 rtx
2262 eliminate_regs (x, mem_mode, insn)
2263 rtx x;
2264 enum machine_mode mem_mode;
2265 rtx insn;
2266 {
2267 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2268 struct elim_table *ep;
2269 int regno;
2270 rtx new;
2271 int i, j;
2272 const char *fmt;
2273 int copied = 0;
2274
2275 if (! current_function_decl)
2276 return x;
2277
2278 switch (code)
2279 {
2280 case CONST_INT:
2281 case CONST_DOUBLE:
2282 case CONST:
2283 case SYMBOL_REF:
2284 case CODE_LABEL:
2285 case PC:
2286 case CC0:
2287 case ASM_INPUT:
2288 case ADDR_VEC:
2289 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2290 case RETURN:
2291 return x;
2292
2293 case ADDRESSOF:
2294 /* This is only for the benefit of the debugging backends, which call
2295 eliminate_regs on DECL_RTL; any ADDRESSOFs in the actual insns are
2296 removed after CSE. */
2297 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), 0, insn);
2298 if (GET_CODE (new) == MEM)
2299 return XEXP (new, 0);
2300 return x;
2301
2302 case REG:
2303 regno = REGNO (x);
2304
2305 /* First handle the case where we encounter a bare register that
2306 is eliminable. Replace it with a PLUS. */
2307 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2308 {
2309 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2310 ep++)
2311 if (ep->from_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
2312 return plus_constant (ep->to_rtx, ep->previous_offset);
2313
2314 }
2315 else if (reg_renumber[regno] < 0 && reg_equiv_constant
2316 && reg_equiv_constant[regno]
2317 && ! CONSTANT_P (reg_equiv_constant[regno]))
2318 return eliminate_regs (copy_rtx (reg_equiv_constant[regno]),
2319 mem_mode, insn);
2320 return x;
2321
2322 /* You might think handling MINUS in a manner similar to PLUS is a
2323 good idea. It is not. It has been tried multiple times and every
2324 time the change has had to have been reverted.
2325
2326 Other parts of reload know a PLUS is special (gen_reload for example)
2327 and require special code to handle code a reloaded PLUS operand.
2328
2329 Also consider backends where the flags register is clobbered by a
2330 MINUS, but we can emit a PLUS that does not clobber flags (ia32,
2331 lea instruction comes to mind). If we try to reload a MINUS, we
2332 may kill the flags register that was holding a useful value.
2333
2334 So, please before trying to handle MINUS, consider reload as a
2335 whole instead of this little section as well as the backend issues. */
2336 case PLUS:
2337 /* If this is the sum of an eliminable register and a constant, rework
2338 the sum. */
2339 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
2340 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2341 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
2342 {
2343 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2344 ep++)
2345 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0) && ep->can_eliminate)
2346 {
2347 /* The only time we want to replace a PLUS with a REG (this
2348 occurs when the constant operand of the PLUS is the negative
2349 of the offset) is when we are inside a MEM. We won't want
2350 to do so at other times because that would change the
2351 structure of the insn in a way that reload can't handle.
2352 We special-case the commonest situation in
2353 eliminate_regs_in_insn, so just replace a PLUS with a
2354 PLUS here, unless inside a MEM. */
2355 if (mem_mode != 0 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
2356 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) == - ep->previous_offset)
2357 return ep->to_rtx;
2358 else
2359 return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, ep->to_rtx,
2360 plus_constant (XEXP (x, 1),
2361 ep->previous_offset));
2362 }
2363
2364 /* If the register is not eliminable, we are done since the other
2365 operand is a constant. */
2366 return x;
2367 }
2368
2369 /* If this is part of an address, we want to bring any constant to the
2370 outermost PLUS. We will do this by doing register replacement in
2371 our operands and seeing if a constant shows up in one of them.
2372
2373 Note that there is no risk of modifying the structure of the insn,
2374 since we only get called for its operands, thus we are either
2375 modifying the address inside a MEM, or something like an address
2376 operand of a load-address insn. */
2377
2378 {
2379 rtx new0 = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn);
2380 rtx new1 = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn);
2381
2382 if (new0 != XEXP (x, 0) || new1 != XEXP (x, 1))
2383 {
2384 /* If one side is a PLUS and the other side is a pseudo that
2385 didn't get a hard register but has a reg_equiv_constant,
2386 we must replace the constant here since it may no longer
2387 be in the position of any operand. */
2388 if (GET_CODE (new0) == PLUS && GET_CODE (new1) == REG
2389 && REGNO (new1) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2390 && reg_renumber[REGNO (new1)] < 0
2391 && reg_equiv_constant != 0
2392 && reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new1)] != 0)
2393 new1 = reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new1)];
2394 else if (GET_CODE (new1) == PLUS && GET_CODE (new0) == REG
2395 && REGNO (new0) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2396 && reg_renumber[REGNO (new0)] < 0
2397 && reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new0)] != 0)
2398 new0 = reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new0)];
2399
2400 new = form_sum (new0, new1);
2401
2402 /* As above, if we are not inside a MEM we do not want to
2403 turn a PLUS into something else. We might try to do so here
2404 for an addition of 0 if we aren't optimizing. */
2405 if (! mem_mode && GET_CODE (new) != PLUS)
2406 return gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (x), new, const0_rtx);
2407 else
2408 return new;
2409 }
2410 }
2411 return x;
2412
2413 case MULT:
2414 /* If this is the product of an eliminable register and a
2415 constant, apply the distribute law and move the constant out
2416 so that we have (plus (mult ..) ..). This is needed in order
2417 to keep load-address insns valid. This case is pathological.
2418 We ignore the possibility of overflow here. */
2419 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
2420 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2421 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
2422 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2423 ep++)
2424 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0) && ep->can_eliminate)
2425 {
2426 if (! mem_mode
2427 /* Refs inside notes don't count for this purpose. */
2428 && ! (insn != 0 && (GET_CODE (insn) == EXPR_LIST
2429 || GET_CODE (insn) == INSN_LIST)))
2430 ep->ref_outside_mem = 1;
2431
2432 return
2433 plus_constant (gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, ep->to_rtx, XEXP (x, 1)),
2434 ep->previous_offset * INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)));
2435 }
2436
2437 /* ... fall through ... */
2438
2439 case CALL:
2440 case COMPARE:
2441 /* See comments before PLUS about handling MINUS. */
2442 case MINUS:
2443 case DIV: case UDIV:
2444 case MOD: case UMOD:
2445 case AND: case IOR: case XOR:
2446 case ROTATERT: case ROTATE:
2447 case ASHIFTRT: case LSHIFTRT: case ASHIFT:
2448 case NE: case EQ:
2449 case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU:
2450 case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU:
2451 {
2452 rtx new0 = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn);
2453 rtx new1
2454 = XEXP (x, 1) ? eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn) : 0;
2455
2456 if (new0 != XEXP (x, 0) || new1 != XEXP (x, 1))
2457 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, GET_MODE (x), new0, new1);
2458 }
2459 return x;
2460
2461 case EXPR_LIST:
2462 /* If we have something in XEXP (x, 0), the usual case, eliminate it. */
2463 if (XEXP (x, 0))
2464 {
2465 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn);
2466 if (new != XEXP (x, 0))
2467 {
2468 /* If this is a REG_DEAD note, it is not valid anymore.
2469 Using the eliminated version could result in creating a
2470 REG_DEAD note for the stack or frame pointer. */
2471 if (GET_MODE (x) == REG_DEAD)
2472 return (XEXP (x, 1)
2473 ? eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn)
2474 : NULL_RTX);
2475
2476 x = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (x), new, XEXP (x, 1));
2477 }
2478 }
2479
2480 /* ... fall through ... */
2481
2482 case INSN_LIST:
2483 /* Now do eliminations in the rest of the chain. If this was
2484 an EXPR_LIST, this might result in allocating more memory than is
2485 strictly needed, but it simplifies the code. */
2486 if (XEXP (x, 1))
2487 {
2488 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn);
2489 if (new != XEXP (x, 1))
2490 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (x), GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0), new);
2491 }
2492 return x;
2493
2494 case PRE_INC:
2495 case POST_INC:
2496 case PRE_DEC:
2497 case POST_DEC:
2498 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
2499 case NEG: case NOT:
2500 case SIGN_EXTEND: case ZERO_EXTEND:
2501 case TRUNCATE: case FLOAT_EXTEND: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
2502 case FLOAT: case FIX:
2503 case UNSIGNED_FIX: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
2504 case ABS:
2505 case SQRT:
2506 case FFS:
2507 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn);
2508 if (new != XEXP (x, 0))
2509 return gen_rtx_fmt_e (code, GET_MODE (x), new);
2510 return x;
2511
2512 case SUBREG:
2513 /* Similar to above processing, but preserve SUBREG_BYTE.
2514 Convert (subreg (mem)) to (mem) if not paradoxical.
2515 Also, if we have a non-paradoxical (subreg (pseudo)) and the
2516 pseudo didn't get a hard reg, we must replace this with the
2517 eliminated version of the memory location because push_reloads
2518 may do the replacement in certain circumstances. */
2519 if (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x)) == REG
2520 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
2521 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
2522 && reg_equiv_memory_loc != 0
2523 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))] != 0)
2524 {
2525 new = SUBREG_REG (x);
2526 }
2527 else
2528 new = eliminate_regs (SUBREG_REG (x), mem_mode, insn);
2529
2530 if (new != SUBREG_REG (x))
2531 {
2532 int x_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x));
2533 int new_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (new));
2534
2535 if (GET_CODE (new) == MEM
2536 && ((x_size < new_size
2537 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
2538 /* On these machines, combine can create rtl of the form
2539 (set (subreg:m1 (reg:m2 R) 0) ...)
2540 where m1 < m2, and expects something interesting to
2541 happen to the entire word. Moreover, it will use the
2542 (reg:m2 R) later, expecting all bits to be preserved.
2543 So if the number of words is the same, preserve the
2544 subreg so that push_reloads can see it. */
2545 && ! ((x_size - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD
2546 == (new_size -1 ) / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2547 #endif
2548 )
2549 || x_size == new_size)
2550 )
2551 {
2552 int offset = SUBREG_BYTE (x);
2553 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
2554
2555 PUT_MODE (new, mode);
2556 XEXP (new, 0) = plus_constant (XEXP (new, 0), offset);
2557 return new;
2558 }
2559 else
2560 return gen_rtx_SUBREG (GET_MODE (x), new, SUBREG_BYTE (x));
2561 }
2562
2563 return x;
2564
2565 case MEM:
2566 /* This is only for the benefit of the debugging backends, which call
2567 eliminate_regs on DECL_RTL; any ADDRESSOFs in the actual insns are
2568 removed after CSE. */
2569 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == ADDRESSOF)
2570 return eliminate_regs (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), 0, insn);
2571
2572 /* Our only special processing is to pass the mode of the MEM to our
2573 recursive call and copy the flags. While we are here, handle this
2574 case more efficiently. */
2575 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x), insn);
2576 if (new != XEXP (x, 0))
2577 {
2578 new = gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (x), new);
2579 MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (new, x);
2580 return new;
2581 }
2582 else
2583 return x;
2584
2585 case USE:
2586 /* Handle insn_list USE that a call to a pure function may generate. */
2587 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), 0, insn);
2588 if (new != XEXP (x, 0))
2589 return gen_rtx_USE (GET_MODE (x), new);
2590 return x;
2591
2592 case CLOBBER:
2593 case ASM_OPERANDS:
2594 case SET:
2595 abort ();
2596
2597 default:
2598 break;
2599 }
2600
2601 /* Process each of our operands recursively. If any have changed, make a
2602 copy of the rtx. */
2603 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
2604 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
2605 {
2606 if (*fmt == 'e')
2607 {
2608 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, i), mem_mode, insn);
2609 if (new != XEXP (x, i) && ! copied)
2610 {
2611 rtx new_x = rtx_alloc (code);
2612 memcpy (new_x, x,
2613 (sizeof (*new_x) - sizeof (new_x->fld)
2614 + sizeof (new_x->fld[0]) * GET_RTX_LENGTH (code)));
2615 x = new_x;
2616 copied = 1;
2617 }
2618 XEXP (x, i) = new;
2619 }
2620 else if (*fmt == 'E')
2621 {
2622 int copied_vec = 0;
2623 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
2624 {
2625 new = eliminate_regs (XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode, insn);
2626 if (new != XVECEXP (x, i, j) && ! copied_vec)
2627 {
2628 rtvec new_v = gen_rtvec_v (XVECLEN (x, i),
2629 XVEC (x, i)->elem);
2630 if (! copied)
2631 {
2632 rtx new_x = rtx_alloc (code);
2633 memcpy (new_x, x,
2634 (sizeof (*new_x) - sizeof (new_x->fld)
2635 + (sizeof (new_x->fld[0])
2636 * GET_RTX_LENGTH (code))));
2637 x = new_x;
2638 copied = 1;
2639 }
2640 XVEC (x, i) = new_v;
2641 copied_vec = 1;
2642 }
2643 XVECEXP (x, i, j) = new;
2644 }
2645 }
2646 }
2647
2648 return x;
2649 }
2650
2651 /* Scan rtx X for modifications of elimination target registers. Update
2652 the table of eliminables to reflect the changed state. MEM_MODE is
2653 the mode of an enclosing MEM rtx, or VOIDmode if not within a MEM. */
2654
2655 static void
2656 elimination_effects (x, mem_mode)
2657 rtx x;
2658 enum machine_mode mem_mode;
2659
2660 {
2661 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2662 struct elim_table *ep;
2663 int regno;
2664 int i, j;
2665 const char *fmt;
2666
2667 switch (code)
2668 {
2669 case CONST_INT:
2670 case CONST_DOUBLE:
2671 case CONST:
2672 case SYMBOL_REF:
2673 case CODE_LABEL:
2674 case PC:
2675 case CC0:
2676 case ASM_INPUT:
2677 case ADDR_VEC:
2678 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2679 case RETURN:
2680 return;
2681
2682 case ADDRESSOF:
2683 abort ();
2684
2685 case REG:
2686 regno = REGNO (x);
2687
2688 /* First handle the case where we encounter a bare register that
2689 is eliminable. Replace it with a PLUS. */
2690 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2691 {
2692 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2693 ep++)
2694 if (ep->from_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
2695 {
2696 if (! mem_mode)
2697 ep->ref_outside_mem = 1;
2698 return;
2699 }
2700
2701 }
2702 else if (reg_renumber[regno] < 0 && reg_equiv_constant
2703 && reg_equiv_constant[regno]
2704 && ! CONSTANT_P (reg_equiv_constant[regno]))
2705 elimination_effects (reg_equiv_constant[regno], mem_mode);
2706 return;
2707
2708 case PRE_INC:
2709 case POST_INC:
2710 case PRE_DEC:
2711 case POST_DEC:
2712 case POST_MODIFY:
2713 case PRE_MODIFY:
2714 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2715 if (ep->to_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
2716 {
2717 int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mem_mode);
2718
2719 /* If more bytes than MEM_MODE are pushed, account for them. */
2720 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
2721 if (ep->to_rtx == stack_pointer_rtx)
2722 size = PUSH_ROUNDING (size);
2723 #endif
2724 if (code == PRE_DEC || code == POST_DEC)
2725 ep->offset += size;
2726 else if (code == PRE_INC || code == POST_INC)
2727 ep->offset -= size;
2728 else if ((code == PRE_MODIFY || code == POST_MODIFY)
2729 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == PLUS
2730 && XEXP (x, 0) == XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0)
2731 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1)))
2732 ep->offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1));
2733 }
2734
2735 /* These two aren't unary operators. */
2736 if (code == POST_MODIFY || code == PRE_MODIFY)
2737 break;
2738
2739 /* Fall through to generic unary operation case. */
2740 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
2741 case NEG: case NOT:
2742 case SIGN_EXTEND: case ZERO_EXTEND:
2743 case TRUNCATE: case FLOAT_EXTEND: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
2744 case FLOAT: case FIX:
2745 case UNSIGNED_FIX: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
2746 case ABS:
2747 case SQRT:
2748 case FFS:
2749 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
2750 return;
2751
2752 case SUBREG:
2753 if (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x)) == REG
2754 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
2755 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
2756 && reg_equiv_memory_loc != 0
2757 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))] != 0)
2758 return;
2759
2760 elimination_effects (SUBREG_REG (x), mem_mode);
2761 return;
2762
2763 case USE:
2764 /* If using a register that is the source of an eliminate we still
2765 think can be performed, note it cannot be performed since we don't
2766 know how this register is used. */
2767 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2768 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
2769 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
2770
2771 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
2772 return;
2773
2774 case CLOBBER:
2775 /* If clobbering a register that is the replacement register for an
2776 elimination we still think can be performed, note that it cannot
2777 be performed. Otherwise, we need not be concerned about it. */
2778 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2779 if (ep->to_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
2780 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
2781
2782 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
2783 return;
2784
2785 case SET:
2786 /* Check for setting a register that we know about. */
2787 if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == REG)
2788 {
2789 /* See if this is setting the replacement register for an
2790 elimination.
2791
2792 If DEST is the hard frame pointer, we do nothing because we
2793 assume that all assignments to the frame pointer are for
2794 non-local gotos and are being done at a time when they are valid
2795 and do not disturb anything else. Some machines want to
2796 eliminate a fake argument pointer (or even a fake frame pointer)
2797 with either the real frame or the stack pointer. Assignments to
2798 the hard frame pointer must not prevent this elimination. */
2799
2800 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2801 ep++)
2802 if (ep->to_rtx == SET_DEST (x)
2803 && SET_DEST (x) != hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2804 {
2805 /* If it is being incremented, adjust the offset. Otherwise,
2806 this elimination can't be done. */
2807 rtx src = SET_SRC (x);
2808
2809 if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
2810 && XEXP (src, 0) == SET_DEST (x)
2811 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
2812 ep->offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2813 else
2814 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
2815 }
2816 }
2817
2818 elimination_effects (SET_DEST (x), 0);
2819 elimination_effects (SET_SRC (x), 0);
2820 return;
2821
2822 case MEM:
2823 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == ADDRESSOF)
2824 abort ();
2825
2826 /* Our only special processing is to pass the mode of the MEM to our
2827 recursive call. */
2828 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x));
2829 return;
2830
2831 default:
2832 break;
2833 }
2834
2835 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
2836 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
2837 {
2838 if (*fmt == 'e')
2839 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, i), mem_mode);
2840 else if (*fmt == 'E')
2841 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
2842 elimination_effects (XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode);
2843 }
2844 }
2845
2846 /* Descend through rtx X and verify that no references to eliminable registers
2847 remain. If any do remain, mark the involved register as not
2848 eliminable. */
2849
2850 static void
2851 check_eliminable_occurrences (x)
2852 rtx x;
2853 {
2854 const char *fmt;
2855 int i;
2856 enum rtx_code code;
2857
2858 if (x == 0)
2859 return;
2860
2861 code = GET_CODE (x);
2862
2863 if (code == REG && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2864 {
2865 struct elim_table *ep;
2866
2867 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2868 if (ep->from_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
2869 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
2870 return;
2871 }
2872
2873 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
2874 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
2875 {
2876 if (*fmt == 'e')
2877 check_eliminable_occurrences (XEXP (x, i));
2878 else if (*fmt == 'E')
2879 {
2880 int j;
2881 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
2882 check_eliminable_occurrences (XVECEXP (x, i, j));
2883 }
2884 }
2885 }
2886 \f
2887 /* Scan INSN and eliminate all eliminable registers in it.
2888
2889 If REPLACE is nonzero, do the replacement destructively. Also
2890 delete the insn as dead it if it is setting an eliminable register.
2891
2892 If REPLACE is zero, do all our allocations in reload_obstack.
2893
2894 If no eliminations were done and this insn doesn't require any elimination
2895 processing (these are not identical conditions: it might be updating sp,
2896 but not referencing fp; this needs to be seen during reload_as_needed so
2897 that the offset between fp and sp can be taken into consideration), zero
2898 is returned. Otherwise, 1 is returned. */
2899
2900 static int
2901 eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn, replace)
2902 rtx insn;
2903 int replace;
2904 {
2905 int icode = recog_memoized (insn);
2906 rtx old_body = PATTERN (insn);
2907 int insn_is_asm = asm_noperands (old_body) >= 0;
2908 rtx old_set = single_set (insn);
2909 rtx new_body;
2910 int val = 0;
2911 int i, any_changes;
2912 rtx substed_operand[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
2913 rtx orig_operand[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
2914 struct elim_table *ep;
2915
2916 if (! insn_is_asm && icode < 0)
2917 {
2918 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
2919 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
2920 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ADDR_VEC
2921 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC
2922 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ASM_INPUT)
2923 return 0;
2924 abort ();
2925 }
2926
2927 if (old_set != 0 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (old_set)) == REG
2928 && REGNO (SET_DEST (old_set)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2929 {
2930 /* Check for setting an eliminable register. */
2931 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2932 if (ep->from_rtx == SET_DEST (old_set) && ep->can_eliminate)
2933 {
2934 #if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2935 /* If this is setting the frame pointer register to the
2936 hardware frame pointer register and this is an elimination
2937 that will be done (tested above), this insn is really
2938 adjusting the frame pointer downward to compensate for
2939 the adjustment done before a nonlocal goto. */
2940 if (ep->from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2941 && ep->to == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
2942 {
2943 rtx src = SET_SRC (old_set);
2944 int offset = 0, ok = 0;
2945 rtx prev_insn, prev_set;
2946
2947 if (src == ep->to_rtx)
2948 offset = 0, ok = 1;
2949 else if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
2950 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == CONST_INT
2951 && XEXP (src, 1) == ep->to_rtx)
2952 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 0)), ok = 1;
2953 else if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
2954 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT
2955 && XEXP (src, 0) == ep->to_rtx)
2956 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1)), ok = 1;
2957 else if ((prev_insn = prev_nonnote_insn (insn)) != 0
2958 && (prev_set = single_set (prev_insn)) != 0
2959 && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (prev_set), src))
2960 {
2961 src = SET_SRC (prev_set);
2962 if (src == ep->to_rtx)
2963 offset = 0, ok = 1;
2964 else if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
2965 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == CONST_INT
2966 && XEXP (src, 1) == ep->to_rtx)
2967 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 0)), ok = 1;
2968 else if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
2969 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT
2970 && XEXP (src, 0) == ep->to_rtx)
2971 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1)), ok = 1;
2972 }
2973
2974 if (ok)
2975 {
2976 if (replace)
2977 {
2978 rtx src
2979 = plus_constant (ep->to_rtx, offset - ep->offset);
2980
2981 /* First see if this insn remains valid when we
2982 make the change. If not, keep the INSN_CODE
2983 the same and let reload fit it up. */
2984 validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (old_set), src, 1);
2985 validate_change (insn, &SET_DEST (old_set),
2986 ep->to_rtx, 1);
2987 if (! apply_change_group ())
2988 {
2989 SET_SRC (old_set) = src;
2990 SET_DEST (old_set) = ep->to_rtx;
2991 }
2992 }
2993
2994 val = 1;
2995 goto done;
2996 }
2997 }
2998 #endif
2999
3000 /* In this case this insn isn't serving a useful purpose. We
3001 will delete it in reload_as_needed once we know that this
3002 elimination is, in fact, being done.
3003
3004 If REPLACE isn't set, we can't delete this insn, but needn't
3005 process it since it won't be used unless something changes. */
3006 if (replace)
3007 {
3008 delete_dead_insn (insn);
3009 return 1;
3010 }
3011 val = 1;
3012 goto done;
3013 }
3014 }
3015
3016 /* We allow one special case which happens to work on all machines we
3017 currently support: a single set with the source being a PLUS of an
3018 eliminable register and a constant. */
3019 if (old_set
3020 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (old_set)) == REG
3021 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == PLUS
3022 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 0)) == REG
3023 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 1)) == CONST_INT
3024 && REGNO (XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3025 {
3026 rtx reg = XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 0);
3027 int offset = INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 1));
3028
3029 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3030 if (ep->from_rtx == reg && ep->can_eliminate)
3031 {
3032 offset += ep->offset;
3033
3034 if (offset == 0)
3035 {
3036 int num_clobbers;
3037 /* We assume here that if we need a PARALLEL with
3038 CLOBBERs for this assignment, we can do with the
3039 MATCH_SCRATCHes that add_clobbers allocates.
3040 There's not much we can do if that doesn't work. */
3041 PATTERN (insn) = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
3042 SET_DEST (old_set),
3043 ep->to_rtx);
3044 num_clobbers = 0;
3045 INSN_CODE (insn) = recog (PATTERN (insn), insn, &num_clobbers);
3046 if (num_clobbers)
3047 {
3048 rtvec vec = rtvec_alloc (num_clobbers + 1);
3049
3050 vec->elem[0] = PATTERN (insn);
3051 PATTERN (insn) = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, vec);
3052 add_clobbers (PATTERN (insn), INSN_CODE (insn));
3053 }
3054 if (INSN_CODE (insn) < 0)
3055 abort ();
3056 }
3057 else
3058 {
3059 new_body = old_body;
3060 if (! replace)
3061 {
3062 new_body = copy_insn (old_body);
3063 if (REG_NOTES (insn))
3064 REG_NOTES (insn) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn));
3065 }
3066 PATTERN (insn) = new_body;
3067 old_set = single_set (insn);
3068
3069 XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 0) = ep->to_rtx;
3070 XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 1) = GEN_INT (offset);
3071 }
3072 val = 1;
3073 /* This can't have an effect on elimination offsets, so skip right
3074 to the end. */
3075 goto done;
3076 }
3077 }
3078
3079 /* Determine the effects of this insn on elimination offsets. */
3080 elimination_effects (old_body, 0);
3081
3082 /* Eliminate all eliminable registers occurring in operands that
3083 can be handled by reload. */
3084 extract_insn (insn);
3085 any_changes = 0;
3086 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3087 {
3088 orig_operand[i] = recog_data.operand[i];
3089 substed_operand[i] = recog_data.operand[i];
3090
3091 /* For an asm statement, every operand is eliminable. */
3092 if (insn_is_asm || insn_data[icode].operand[i].eliminable)
3093 {
3094 /* Check for setting a register that we know about. */
3095 if (recog_data.operand_type[i] != OP_IN
3096 && GET_CODE (orig_operand[i]) == REG)
3097 {
3098 /* If we are assigning to a register that can be eliminated, it
3099 must be as part of a PARALLEL, since the code above handles
3100 single SETs. We must indicate that we can no longer
3101 eliminate this reg. */
3102 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
3103 ep++)
3104 if (ep->from_rtx == orig_operand[i] && ep->can_eliminate)
3105 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3106 }
3107
3108 substed_operand[i] = eliminate_regs (recog_data.operand[i], 0,
3109 replace ? insn : NULL_RTX);
3110 if (substed_operand[i] != orig_operand[i])
3111 val = any_changes = 1;
3112 /* Terminate the search in check_eliminable_occurrences at
3113 this point. */
3114 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = 0;
3115
3116 /* If an output operand changed from a REG to a MEM and INSN is an
3117 insn, write a CLOBBER insn. */
3118 if (recog_data.operand_type[i] != OP_IN
3119 && GET_CODE (orig_operand[i]) == REG
3120 && GET_CODE (substed_operand[i]) == MEM
3121 && replace)
3122 emit_insn_after (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, orig_operand[i]),
3123 insn);
3124 }
3125 }
3126
3127 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3128 *recog_data.dup_loc[i]
3129 = *recog_data.operand_loc[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3130
3131 /* If any eliminable remain, they aren't eliminable anymore. */
3132 check_eliminable_occurrences (old_body);
3133
3134 /* Substitute the operands; the new values are in the substed_operand
3135 array. */
3136 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3137 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = substed_operand[i];
3138 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3139 *recog_data.dup_loc[i] = substed_operand[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3140
3141 /* If we are replacing a body that was a (set X (plus Y Z)), try to
3142 re-recognize the insn. We do this in case we had a simple addition
3143 but now can do this as a load-address. This saves an insn in this
3144 common case.
3145 If re-recognition fails, the old insn code number will still be used,
3146 and some register operands may have changed into PLUS expressions.
3147 These will be handled by find_reloads by loading them into a register
3148 again. */
3149
3150 if (val)
3151 {
3152 /* If we aren't replacing things permanently and we changed something,
3153 make another copy to ensure that all the RTL is new. Otherwise
3154 things can go wrong if find_reload swaps commutative operands
3155 and one is inside RTL that has been copied while the other is not. */
3156 new_body = old_body;
3157 if (! replace)
3158 {
3159 new_body = copy_insn (old_body);
3160 if (REG_NOTES (insn))
3161 REG_NOTES (insn) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn));
3162 }
3163 PATTERN (insn) = new_body;
3164
3165 /* If we had a move insn but now we don't, rerecognize it. This will
3166 cause spurious re-recognition if the old move had a PARALLEL since
3167 the new one still will, but we can't call single_set without
3168 having put NEW_BODY into the insn and the re-recognition won't
3169 hurt in this rare case. */
3170 /* ??? Why this huge if statement - why don't we just rerecognize the
3171 thing always? */
3172 if (! insn_is_asm
3173 && old_set != 0
3174 && ((GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == REG
3175 && (GET_CODE (new_body) != SET
3176 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (new_body)) != REG))
3177 /* If this was a load from or store to memory, compare
3178 the MEM in recog_data.operand to the one in the insn.
3179 If they are not equal, then rerecognize the insn. */
3180 || (old_set != 0
3181 && ((GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == MEM
3182 && SET_SRC (old_set) != recog_data.operand[1])
3183 || (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (old_set)) == MEM
3184 && SET_DEST (old_set) != recog_data.operand[0])))
3185 /* If this was an add insn before, rerecognize. */
3186 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == PLUS))
3187 {
3188 int new_icode = recog (PATTERN (insn), insn, 0);
3189 if (new_icode < 0)
3190 INSN_CODE (insn) = icode;
3191 }
3192 }
3193
3194 /* Restore the old body. If there were any changes to it, we made a copy
3195 of it while the changes were still in place, so we'll correctly return
3196 a modified insn below. */
3197 if (! replace)
3198 {
3199 /* Restore the old body. */
3200 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3201 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = orig_operand[i];
3202 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3203 *recog_data.dup_loc[i] = orig_operand[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3204 }
3205
3206 /* Update all elimination pairs to reflect the status after the current
3207 insn. The changes we make were determined by the earlier call to
3208 elimination_effects.
3209
3210 We also detect a cases where register elimination cannot be done,
3211 namely, if a register would be both changed and referenced outside a MEM
3212 in the resulting insn since such an insn is often undefined and, even if
3213 not, we cannot know what meaning will be given to it. Note that it is
3214 valid to have a register used in an address in an insn that changes it
3215 (presumably with a pre- or post-increment or decrement).
3216
3217 If anything changes, return nonzero. */
3218
3219 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3220 {
3221 if (ep->previous_offset != ep->offset && ep->ref_outside_mem)
3222 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3223
3224 ep->ref_outside_mem = 0;
3225
3226 if (ep->previous_offset != ep->offset)
3227 val = 1;
3228 }
3229
3230 done:
3231 /* If we changed something, perform elimination in REG_NOTES. This is
3232 needed even when REPLACE is zero because a REG_DEAD note might refer
3233 to a register that we eliminate and could cause a different number
3234 of spill registers to be needed in the final reload pass than in
3235 the pre-passes. */
3236 if (val && REG_NOTES (insn) != 0)
3237 REG_NOTES (insn) = eliminate_regs (REG_NOTES (insn), 0, REG_NOTES (insn));
3238
3239 return val;
3240 }
3241
3242 /* Loop through all elimination pairs.
3243 Recalculate the number not at initial offset.
3244
3245 Compute the maximum offset (minimum offset if the stack does not
3246 grow downward) for each elimination pair. */
3247
3248 static void
3249 update_eliminable_offsets ()
3250 {
3251 struct elim_table *ep;
3252
3253 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3254 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3255 {
3256 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset;
3257 if (ep->can_eliminate && ep->offset != ep->initial_offset)
3258 num_not_at_initial_offset++;
3259 }
3260 }
3261
3262 /* Given X, a SET or CLOBBER of DEST, if DEST is the target of a register
3263 replacement we currently believe is valid, mark it as not eliminable if X
3264 modifies DEST in any way other than by adding a constant integer to it.
3265
3266 If DEST is the frame pointer, we do nothing because we assume that
3267 all assignments to the hard frame pointer are nonlocal gotos and are being
3268 done at a time when they are valid and do not disturb anything else.
3269 Some machines want to eliminate a fake argument pointer with either the
3270 frame or stack pointer. Assignments to the hard frame pointer must not
3271 prevent this elimination.
3272
3273 Called via note_stores from reload before starting its passes to scan
3274 the insns of the function. */
3275
3276 static void
3277 mark_not_eliminable (dest, x, data)
3278 rtx dest;
3279 rtx x;
3280 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
3281 {
3282 register unsigned int i;
3283
3284 /* A SUBREG of a hard register here is just changing its mode. We should
3285 not see a SUBREG of an eliminable hard register, but check just in
3286 case. */
3287 if (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG)
3288 dest = SUBREG_REG (dest);
3289
3290 if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
3291 return;
3292
3293 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
3294 if (reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate && dest == reg_eliminate[i].to_rtx
3295 && (GET_CODE (x) != SET
3296 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) != PLUS
3297 || XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0) != dest
3298 || GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1)) != CONST_INT))
3299 {
3300 reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate_previous
3301 = reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate = 0;
3302 num_eliminable--;
3303 }
3304 }
3305
3306 /* Verify that the initial elimination offsets did not change since the
3307 last call to set_initial_elim_offsets. This is used to catch cases
3308 where something illegal happened during reload_as_needed that could
3309 cause incorrect code to be generated if we did not check for it. */
3310
3311 static void
3312 verify_initial_elim_offsets ()
3313 {
3314 int t;
3315
3316 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3317 struct elim_table *ep;
3318
3319 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3320 {
3321 INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (ep->from, ep->to, t);
3322 if (t != ep->initial_offset)
3323 abort ();
3324 }
3325 #else
3326 INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (t);
3327 if (t != reg_eliminate[0].initial_offset)
3328 abort ();
3329 #endif
3330 }
3331
3332 /* Reset all offsets on eliminable registers to their initial values. */
3333
3334 static void
3335 set_initial_elim_offsets ()
3336 {
3337 struct elim_table *ep = reg_eliminate;
3338
3339 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3340 for (; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3341 {
3342 INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (ep->from, ep->to, ep->initial_offset);
3343 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset = ep->initial_offset;
3344 }
3345 #else
3346 INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (ep->initial_offset);
3347 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset = ep->initial_offset;
3348 #endif
3349
3350 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3351 }
3352
3353 /* Initialize the known label offsets.
3354 Set a known offset for each forced label to be at the initial offset
3355 of each elimination. We do this because we assume that all
3356 computed jumps occur from a location where each elimination is
3357 at its initial offset.
3358 For all other labels, show that we don't know the offsets. */
3359
3360 static void
3361 set_initial_label_offsets ()
3362 {
3363 rtx x;
3364 memset ((char *) &offsets_known_at[get_first_label_num ()], 0, num_labels);
3365
3366 for (x = forced_labels; x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
3367 if (XEXP (x, 0))
3368 set_label_offsets (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, 1);
3369 }
3370
3371 /* Set all elimination offsets to the known values for the code label given
3372 by INSN. */
3373
3374 static void
3375 set_offsets_for_label (insn)
3376 rtx insn;
3377 {
3378 unsigned int i;
3379 int label_nr = CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn);
3380 struct elim_table *ep;
3381
3382 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3383 for (i = 0, ep = reg_eliminate; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; ep++, i++)
3384 {
3385 ep->offset = ep->previous_offset = offsets_at[label_nr][i];
3386 if (ep->can_eliminate && ep->offset != ep->initial_offset)
3387 num_not_at_initial_offset++;
3388 }
3389 }
3390
3391 /* See if anything that happened changes which eliminations are valid.
3392 For example, on the Sparc, whether or not the frame pointer can
3393 be eliminated can depend on what registers have been used. We need
3394 not check some conditions again (such as flag_omit_frame_pointer)
3395 since they can't have changed. */
3396
3397 static void
3398 update_eliminables (pset)
3399 HARD_REG_SET *pset;
3400 {
3401 #if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3402 int previous_frame_pointer_needed = frame_pointer_needed;
3403 #endif
3404 struct elim_table *ep;
3405
3406 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3407 if ((ep->from == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED)
3408 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3409 || ! CAN_ELIMINATE (ep->from, ep->to)
3410 #endif
3411 )
3412 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3413
3414 /* Look for the case where we have discovered that we can't replace
3415 register A with register B and that means that we will now be
3416 trying to replace register A with register C. This means we can
3417 no longer replace register C with register B and we need to disable
3418 such an elimination, if it exists. This occurs often with A == ap,
3419 B == sp, and C == fp. */
3420
3421 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3422 {
3423 struct elim_table *op;
3424 register int new_to = -1;
3425
3426 if (! ep->can_eliminate && ep->can_eliminate_previous)
3427 {
3428 /* Find the current elimination for ep->from, if there is a
3429 new one. */
3430 for (op = reg_eliminate;
3431 op < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; op++)
3432 if (op->from == ep->from && op->can_eliminate)
3433 {
3434 new_to = op->to;
3435 break;
3436 }
3437
3438 /* See if there is an elimination of NEW_TO -> EP->TO. If so,
3439 disable it. */
3440 for (op = reg_eliminate;
3441 op < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; op++)
3442 if (op->from == new_to && op->to == ep->to)
3443 op->can_eliminate = 0;
3444 }
3445 }
3446
3447 /* See if any registers that we thought we could eliminate the previous
3448 time are no longer eliminable. If so, something has changed and we
3449 must spill the register. Also, recompute the number of eliminable
3450 registers and see if the frame pointer is needed; it is if there is
3451 no elimination of the frame pointer that we can perform. */
3452
3453 frame_pointer_needed = 1;
3454 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3455 {
3456 if (ep->can_eliminate && ep->from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3457 && ep->to != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
3458 frame_pointer_needed = 0;
3459
3460 if (! ep->can_eliminate && ep->can_eliminate_previous)
3461 {
3462 ep->can_eliminate_previous = 0;
3463 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*pset, ep->from);
3464 num_eliminable--;
3465 }
3466 }
3467
3468 #if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3469 /* If we didn't need a frame pointer last time, but we do now, spill
3470 the hard frame pointer. */
3471 if (frame_pointer_needed && ! previous_frame_pointer_needed)
3472 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*pset, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
3473 #endif
3474 }
3475
3476 /* Initialize the table of registers to eliminate. */
3477
3478 static void
3479 init_elim_table ()
3480 {
3481 struct elim_table *ep;
3482 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3483 struct elim_table_1 *ep1;
3484 #endif
3485
3486 if (!reg_eliminate)
3487 reg_eliminate = (struct elim_table *)
3488 xcalloc (sizeof (struct elim_table), NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS);
3489
3490 /* Does this function require a frame pointer? */
3491
3492 frame_pointer_needed = (! flag_omit_frame_pointer
3493 #ifdef EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
3494 /* ?? If EXIT_IGNORE_STACK is set, we will not save
3495 and restore sp for alloca. So we can't eliminate
3496 the frame pointer in that case. At some point,
3497 we should improve this by emitting the
3498 sp-adjusting insns for this case. */
3499 || (current_function_calls_alloca
3500 && EXIT_IGNORE_STACK)
3501 #endif
3502 || FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED);
3503
3504 num_eliminable = 0;
3505
3506 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3507 for (ep = reg_eliminate, ep1 = reg_eliminate_1;
3508 ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++, ep1++)
3509 {
3510 ep->from = ep1->from;
3511 ep->to = ep1->to;
3512 ep->can_eliminate = ep->can_eliminate_previous
3513 = (CAN_ELIMINATE (ep->from, ep->to)
3514 && ! (ep->to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM && frame_pointer_needed));
3515 }
3516 #else
3517 reg_eliminate[0].from = reg_eliminate_1[0].from;
3518 reg_eliminate[0].to = reg_eliminate_1[0].to;
3519 reg_eliminate[0].can_eliminate = reg_eliminate[0].can_eliminate_previous
3520 = ! frame_pointer_needed;
3521 #endif
3522
3523 /* Count the number of eliminable registers and build the FROM and TO
3524 REG rtx's. Note that code in gen_rtx will cause, e.g.,
3525 gen_rtx (REG, Pmode, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM) to equal stack_pointer_rtx.
3526 We depend on this. */
3527 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3528 {
3529 num_eliminable += ep->can_eliminate;
3530 ep->from_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, ep->from);
3531 ep->to_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, ep->to);
3532 }
3533 }
3534 \f
3535 /* Kick all pseudos out of hard register REGNO.
3536
3537 If CANT_ELIMINATE is nonzero, it means that we are doing this spill
3538 because we found we can't eliminate some register. In the case, no pseudos
3539 are allowed to be in the register, even if they are only in a block that
3540 doesn't require spill registers, unlike the case when we are spilling this
3541 hard reg to produce another spill register.
3542
3543 Return nonzero if any pseudos needed to be kicked out. */
3544
3545 static void
3546 spill_hard_reg (regno, cant_eliminate)
3547 unsigned int regno;
3548 int cant_eliminate;
3549 {
3550 register int i;
3551
3552 if (cant_eliminate)
3553 {
3554 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs_global, regno);
3555 regs_ever_live[regno] = 1;
3556 }
3557
3558 /* Spill every pseudo reg that was allocated to this reg
3559 or to something that overlaps this reg. */
3560
3561 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
3562 if (reg_renumber[i] >= 0
3563 && (unsigned int) reg_renumber[i] <= regno
3564 && ((unsigned int) reg_renumber[i]
3565 + HARD_REGNO_NREGS ((unsigned int) reg_renumber[i],
3566 PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (i))
3567 > regno))
3568 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, i);
3569 }
3570
3571 /* I'm getting weird preprocessor errors if I use IOR_HARD_REG_SET
3572 from within EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET. Hence this awkwardness. */
3573
3574 static void
3575 ior_hard_reg_set (set1, set2)
3576 HARD_REG_SET *set1, *set2;
3577 {
3578 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (*set1, *set2);
3579 }
3580
3581 /* After find_reload_regs has been run for all insn that need reloads,
3582 and/or spill_hard_regs was called, this function is used to actually
3583 spill pseudo registers and try to reallocate them. It also sets up the
3584 spill_regs array for use by choose_reload_regs. */
3585
3586 static int
3587 finish_spills (global)
3588 int global;
3589 {
3590 struct insn_chain *chain;
3591 int something_changed = 0;
3592 int i;
3593
3594 /* Build the spill_regs array for the function. */
3595 /* If there are some registers still to eliminate and one of the spill regs
3596 wasn't ever used before, additional stack space may have to be
3597 allocated to store this register. Thus, we may have changed the offset
3598 between the stack and frame pointers, so mark that something has changed.
3599
3600 One might think that we need only set VAL to 1 if this is a call-used
3601 register. However, the set of registers that must be saved by the
3602 prologue is not identical to the call-used set. For example, the
3603 register used by the call insn for the return PC is a call-used register,
3604 but must be saved by the prologue. */
3605
3606 n_spills = 0;
3607 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
3608 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs, i))
3609 {
3610 spill_reg_order[i] = n_spills;
3611 spill_regs[n_spills++] = i;
3612 if (num_eliminable && ! regs_ever_live[i])
3613 something_changed = 1;
3614 regs_ever_live[i] = 1;
3615 }
3616 else
3617 spill_reg_order[i] = -1;
3618
3619 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
3620 (&spilled_pseudos, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i,
3621 {
3622 /* Record the current hard register the pseudo is allocated to in
3623 pseudo_previous_regs so we avoid reallocating it to the same
3624 hard reg in a later pass. */
3625 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0)
3626 abort ();
3627
3628 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (pseudo_previous_regs[i], reg_renumber[i]);
3629 /* Mark it as no longer having a hard register home. */
3630 reg_renumber[i] = -1;
3631 /* We will need to scan everything again. */
3632 something_changed = 1;
3633 });
3634
3635 /* Retry global register allocation if possible. */
3636 if (global)
3637 {
3638 memset ((char *) pseudo_forbidden_regs, 0, max_regno * sizeof (HARD_REG_SET));
3639 /* For every insn that needs reloads, set the registers used as spill
3640 regs in pseudo_forbidden_regs for every pseudo live across the
3641 insn. */
3642 for (chain = insns_need_reload; chain; chain = chain->next_need_reload)
3643 {
3644 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
3645 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i,
3646 {
3647 ior_hard_reg_set (pseudo_forbidden_regs + i,
3648 &chain->used_spill_regs);
3649 });
3650 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
3651 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i,
3652 {
3653 ior_hard_reg_set (pseudo_forbidden_regs + i,
3654 &chain->used_spill_regs);
3655 });
3656 }
3657
3658 /* Retry allocating the spilled pseudos. For each reg, merge the
3659 various reg sets that indicate which hard regs can't be used,
3660 and call retry_global_alloc.
3661 We change spill_pseudos here to only contain pseudos that did not
3662 get a new hard register. */
3663 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
3664 if (reg_old_renumber[i] != reg_renumber[i])
3665 {
3666 HARD_REG_SET forbidden;
3667 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (forbidden, bad_spill_regs_global);
3668 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (forbidden, pseudo_forbidden_regs[i]);
3669 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (forbidden, pseudo_previous_regs[i]);
3670 retry_global_alloc (i, forbidden);
3671 if (reg_renumber[i] >= 0)
3672 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, i);
3673 }
3674 }
3675
3676 /* Fix up the register information in the insn chain.
3677 This involves deleting those of the spilled pseudos which did not get
3678 a new hard register home from the live_{before,after} sets. */
3679 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain; chain = chain->next)
3680 {
3681 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos;
3682 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos2;
3683
3684 AND_COMPL_REG_SET (&chain->live_throughout, &spilled_pseudos);
3685 AND_COMPL_REG_SET (&chain->dead_or_set, &spilled_pseudos);
3686
3687 /* Mark any unallocated hard regs as available for spills. That
3688 makes inheritance work somewhat better. */
3689 if (chain->need_reload)
3690 {
3691 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
3692 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2, &chain->dead_or_set);
3693 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, used_by_pseudos2);
3694
3695 /* Save the old value for the sanity test below. */
3696 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2, chain->used_spill_regs);
3697
3698 compute_use_by_pseudos (&used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
3699 compute_use_by_pseudos (&used_by_pseudos, &chain->dead_or_set);
3700 COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos);
3701 AND_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs);
3702
3703 /* Make sure we only enlarge the set. */
3704 GO_IF_HARD_REG_SUBSET (used_by_pseudos2, chain->used_spill_regs, ok);
3705 abort ();
3706 ok:;
3707 }
3708 }
3709
3710 /* Let alter_reg modify the reg rtx's for the modified pseudos. */
3711 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
3712 {
3713 int regno = reg_renumber[i];
3714 if (reg_old_renumber[i] == regno)
3715 continue;
3716
3717 alter_reg (i, reg_old_renumber[i]);
3718 reg_old_renumber[i] = regno;
3719 if (rtl_dump_file)
3720 {
3721 if (regno == -1)
3722 fprintf (rtl_dump_file, " Register %d now on stack.\n\n", i);
3723 else
3724 fprintf (rtl_dump_file, " Register %d now in %d.\n\n",
3725 i, reg_renumber[i]);
3726 }
3727 }
3728
3729 return something_changed;
3730 }
3731 \f
3732 /* Find all paradoxical subregs within X and update reg_max_ref_width.
3733 Also mark any hard registers used to store user variables as
3734 forbidden from being used for spill registers. */
3735
3736 static void
3737 scan_paradoxical_subregs (x)
3738 register rtx x;
3739 {
3740 register int i;
3741 register const char *fmt;
3742 register enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
3743
3744 switch (code)
3745 {
3746 case REG:
3747 #if 0
3748 if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
3749 && REG_USERVAR_P (x))
3750 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs_global, REGNO (x));
3751 #endif
3752 return;
3753
3754 case CONST_INT:
3755 case CONST:
3756 case SYMBOL_REF:
3757 case LABEL_REF:
3758 case CONST_DOUBLE:
3759 case CC0:
3760 case PC:
3761 case USE:
3762 case CLOBBER:
3763 return;
3764
3765 case SUBREG:
3766 if (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x)) == REG
3767 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)) > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
3768 reg_max_ref_width[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))]
3769 = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x));
3770 return;
3771
3772 default:
3773 break;
3774 }
3775
3776 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
3777 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
3778 {
3779 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
3780 scan_paradoxical_subregs (XEXP (x, i));
3781 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
3782 {
3783 register int j;
3784 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
3785 scan_paradoxical_subregs (XVECEXP (x, i, j));
3786 }
3787 }
3788 }
3789 \f
3790 /* Reload pseudo-registers into hard regs around each insn as needed.
3791 Additional register load insns are output before the insn that needs it
3792 and perhaps store insns after insns that modify the reloaded pseudo reg.
3793
3794 reg_last_reload_reg and reg_reloaded_contents keep track of
3795 which registers are already available in reload registers.
3796 We update these for the reloads that we perform,
3797 as the insns are scanned. */
3798
3799 static void
3800 reload_as_needed (live_known)
3801 int live_known;
3802 {
3803 struct insn_chain *chain;
3804 #if defined (AUTO_INC_DEC)
3805 register int i;
3806 #endif
3807 rtx x;
3808
3809 memset ((char *) spill_reg_rtx, 0, sizeof spill_reg_rtx);
3810 memset ((char *) spill_reg_store, 0, sizeof spill_reg_store);
3811 reg_last_reload_reg = (rtx *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (rtx));
3812 reg_has_output_reload = (char *) xmalloc (max_regno);
3813 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid);
3814
3815 set_initial_elim_offsets ();
3816
3817 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain; chain = chain->next)
3818 {
3819 rtx prev;
3820 rtx insn = chain->insn;
3821 rtx old_next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
3822
3823 /* If we pass a label, copy the offsets from the label information
3824 into the current offsets of each elimination. */
3825 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL)
3826 set_offsets_for_label (insn);
3827
3828 else if (INSN_P (insn))
3829 {
3830 rtx oldpat = PATTERN (insn);
3831
3832 /* If this is a USE and CLOBBER of a MEM, ensure that any
3833 references to eliminable registers have been removed. */
3834
3835 if ((GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
3836 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER)
3837 && GET_CODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)) == MEM)
3838 XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0)
3839 = eliminate_regs (XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0),
3840 GET_MODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)),
3841 NULL_RTX);
3842
3843 /* If we need to do register elimination processing, do so.
3844 This might delete the insn, in which case we are done. */
3845 if ((num_eliminable || num_eliminable_invariants) && chain->need_elim)
3846 {
3847 eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn, 1);
3848 if (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE)
3849 {
3850 update_eliminable_offsets ();
3851 continue;
3852 }
3853 }
3854
3855 /* If need_elim is nonzero but need_reload is zero, one might think
3856 that we could simply set n_reloads to 0. However, find_reloads
3857 could have done some manipulation of the insn (such as swapping
3858 commutative operands), and these manipulations are lost during
3859 the first pass for every insn that needs register elimination.
3860 So the actions of find_reloads must be redone here. */
3861
3862 if (! chain->need_elim && ! chain->need_reload
3863 && ! chain->need_operand_change)
3864 n_reloads = 0;
3865 /* First find the pseudo regs that must be reloaded for this insn.
3866 This info is returned in the tables reload_... (see reload.h).
3867 Also modify the body of INSN by substituting RELOAD
3868 rtx's for those pseudo regs. */
3869 else
3870 {
3871 memset (reg_has_output_reload, 0, max_regno);
3872 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_is_output_reload);
3873
3874 find_reloads (insn, 1, spill_indirect_levels, live_known,
3875 spill_reg_order);
3876 }
3877
3878 if (n_reloads > 0)
3879 {
3880 rtx next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
3881 rtx p;
3882
3883 prev = PREV_INSN (insn);
3884
3885 /* Now compute which reload regs to reload them into. Perhaps
3886 reusing reload regs from previous insns, or else output
3887 load insns to reload them. Maybe output store insns too.
3888 Record the choices of reload reg in reload_reg_rtx. */
3889 choose_reload_regs (chain);
3890
3891 /* Merge any reloads that we didn't combine for fear of
3892 increasing the number of spill registers needed but now
3893 discover can be safely merged. */
3894 if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES)
3895 merge_assigned_reloads (insn);
3896
3897 /* Generate the insns to reload operands into or out of
3898 their reload regs. */
3899 emit_reload_insns (chain);
3900
3901 /* Substitute the chosen reload regs from reload_reg_rtx
3902 into the insn's body (or perhaps into the bodies of other
3903 load and store insn that we just made for reloading
3904 and that we moved the structure into). */
3905 subst_reloads (insn);
3906
3907 /* If this was an ASM, make sure that all the reload insns
3908 we have generated are valid. If not, give an error
3909 and delete them. */
3910
3911 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
3912 for (p = NEXT_INSN (prev); p != next; p = NEXT_INSN (p))
3913 if (p != insn && INSN_P (p)
3914 && (recog_memoized (p) < 0
3915 || (extract_insn (p), ! constrain_operands (1))))
3916 {
3917 error_for_asm (insn,
3918 "`asm' operand requires impossible reload");
3919 PUT_CODE (p, NOTE);
3920 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (p) = 0;
3921 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (p) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
3922 }
3923 }
3924
3925 if (num_eliminable && chain->need_elim)
3926 update_eliminable_offsets ();
3927
3928 /* Any previously reloaded spilled pseudo reg, stored in this insn,
3929 is no longer validly lying around to save a future reload.
3930 Note that this does not detect pseudos that were reloaded
3931 for this insn in order to be stored in
3932 (obeying register constraints). That is correct; such reload
3933 registers ARE still valid. */
3934 note_stores (oldpat, forget_old_reloads_1, NULL);
3935
3936 /* There may have been CLOBBER insns placed after INSN. So scan
3937 between INSN and NEXT and use them to forget old reloads. */
3938 for (x = NEXT_INSN (insn); x != old_next; x = NEXT_INSN (x))
3939 if (GET_CODE (x) == INSN && GET_CODE (PATTERN (x)) == CLOBBER)
3940 note_stores (PATTERN (x), forget_old_reloads_1, NULL);
3941
3942 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
3943 /* Likewise for regs altered by auto-increment in this insn.
3944 REG_INC notes have been changed by reloading:
3945 find_reloads_address_1 records substitutions for them,
3946 which have been performed by subst_reloads above. */
3947 for (i = n_reloads - 1; i >= 0; i--)
3948 {
3949 rtx in_reg = rld[i].in_reg;
3950 if (in_reg)
3951 {
3952 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (in_reg);
3953 /* PRE_INC / PRE_DEC will have the reload register ending up
3954 with the same value as the stack slot, but that doesn't
3955 hold true for POST_INC / POST_DEC. Either we have to
3956 convert the memory access to a true POST_INC / POST_DEC,
3957 or we can't use the reload register for inheritance. */
3958 if ((code == POST_INC || code == POST_DEC)
3959 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid,
3960 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx))
3961 /* Make sure it is the inc/dec pseudo, and not
3962 some other (e.g. output operand) pseudo. */
3963 && (reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx)]
3964 == REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0))))
3965
3966 {
3967 rtx reload_reg = rld[i].reg_rtx;
3968 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (reload_reg);
3969 int n = 0;
3970 rtx p;
3971
3972 for (p = PREV_INSN (old_next); p != prev; p = PREV_INSN (p))
3973 {
3974 /* We really want to ignore REG_INC notes here, so
3975 use PATTERN (p) as argument to reg_set_p . */
3976 if (reg_set_p (reload_reg, PATTERN (p)))
3977 break;
3978 n = count_occurrences (PATTERN (p), reload_reg, 0);
3979 if (! n)
3980 continue;
3981 if (n == 1)
3982 {
3983 n = validate_replace_rtx (reload_reg,
3984 gen_rtx (code, mode,
3985 reload_reg),
3986 p);
3987
3988 /* We must also verify that the constraints
3989 are met after the replacement. */
3990 extract_insn (p);
3991 if (n)
3992 n = constrain_operands (1);
3993 else
3994 break;
3995
3996 /* If the constraints were not met, then
3997 undo the replacement. */
3998 if (!n)
3999 {
4000 validate_replace_rtx (gen_rtx (code, mode,
4001 reload_reg),
4002 reload_reg, p);
4003 break;
4004 }
4005
4006 }
4007 break;
4008 }
4009 if (n == 1)
4010 {
4011 REG_NOTES (p)
4012 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_INC, reload_reg,
4013 REG_NOTES (p));
4014 /* Mark this as having an output reload so that the
4015 REG_INC processing code below won't invalidate
4016 the reload for inheritance. */
4017 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
4018 REGNO (reload_reg));
4019 reg_has_output_reload[REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0))] = 1;
4020 }
4021 else
4022 forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (in_reg, 0), NULL_RTX,
4023 NULL);
4024 }
4025 else if ((code == PRE_INC || code == PRE_DEC)
4026 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid,
4027 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx))
4028 /* Make sure it is the inc/dec pseudo, and not
4029 some other (e.g. output operand) pseudo. */
4030 && (reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx)]
4031 == REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0))))
4032 {
4033 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
4034 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx));
4035 reg_has_output_reload[REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0))] = 1;
4036 }
4037 }
4038 }
4039 /* If a pseudo that got a hard register is auto-incremented,
4040 we must purge records of copying it into pseudos without
4041 hard registers. */
4042 for (x = REG_NOTES (insn); x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
4043 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (x) == REG_INC)
4044 {
4045 /* See if this pseudo reg was reloaded in this insn.
4046 If so, its last-reload info is still valid
4047 because it is based on this insn's reload. */
4048 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
4049 if (rld[i].out == XEXP (x, 0))
4050 break;
4051
4052 if (i == n_reloads)
4053 forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, NULL);
4054 }
4055 #endif
4056 }
4057 /* A reload reg's contents are unknown after a label. */
4058 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL)
4059 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid);
4060
4061 /* Don't assume a reload reg is still good after a call insn
4062 if it is a call-used reg. */
4063 else if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
4064 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET(reg_reloaded_valid, call_used_reg_set);
4065 }
4066
4067 /* Clean up. */
4068 free (reg_last_reload_reg);
4069 free (reg_has_output_reload);
4070 }
4071
4072 /* Discard all record of any value reloaded from X,
4073 or reloaded in X from someplace else;
4074 unless X is an output reload reg of the current insn.
4075
4076 X may be a hard reg (the reload reg)
4077 or it may be a pseudo reg that was reloaded from. */
4078
4079 static void
4080 forget_old_reloads_1 (x, ignored, data)
4081 rtx x;
4082 rtx ignored ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4083 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4084 {
4085 unsigned int regno;
4086 unsigned int nr;
4087 int offset = 0;
4088
4089 /* note_stores does give us subregs of hard regs,
4090 subreg_regno_offset will abort if it is not a hard reg. */
4091 while (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
4092 {
4093 offset += subreg_regno_offset (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x)),
4094 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)),
4095 SUBREG_BYTE (x),
4096 GET_MODE (x));
4097 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
4098 }
4099
4100 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG)
4101 return;
4102
4103 regno = REGNO (x) + offset;
4104
4105 if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4106 nr = 1;
4107 else
4108 {
4109 unsigned int i;
4110
4111 nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (x));
4112 /* Storing into a spilled-reg invalidates its contents.
4113 This can happen if a block-local pseudo is allocated to that reg
4114 and it wasn't spilled because this block's total need is 0.
4115 Then some insn might have an optional reload and use this reg. */
4116 for (i = 0; i < nr; i++)
4117 /* But don't do this if the reg actually serves as an output
4118 reload reg in the current instruction. */
4119 if (n_reloads == 0
4120 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, regno + i))
4121 {
4122 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno + i);
4123 spill_reg_store[regno + i] = 0;
4124 }
4125 }
4126
4127 /* Since value of X has changed,
4128 forget any value previously copied from it. */
4129
4130 while (nr-- > 0)
4131 /* But don't forget a copy if this is the output reload
4132 that establishes the copy's validity. */
4133 if (n_reloads == 0 || reg_has_output_reload[regno + nr] == 0)
4134 reg_last_reload_reg[regno + nr] = 0;
4135 }
4136 \f
4137 /* The following HARD_REG_SETs indicate when each hard register is
4138 used for a reload of various parts of the current insn. */
4139
4140 /* If reg is unavailable for all reloads. */
4141 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_unavailable;
4142 /* If reg is in use as a reload reg for a RELOAD_OTHER reload. */
4143 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used;
4144 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4145 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4146 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4147 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4148 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4149 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4150 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4151 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4152 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reload for operand I. */
4153 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_input[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4154 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reload for operand I. */
4155 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_output[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4156 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reload. */
4157 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_op_addr;
4158 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR reload. */
4159 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload;
4160 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INSN reload. */
4161 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_insn;
4162 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reload. */
4163 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_other_addr;
4164
4165 /* If reg is in use as a reload reg for any sort of reload. */
4166 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_at_all;
4167
4168 /* If reg is use as an inherited reload. We just mark the first register
4169 in the group. */
4170 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_for_inherit;
4171
4172 /* Records which hard regs are used in any way, either as explicit use or
4173 by being allocated to a pseudo during any point of the current insn. */
4174 static HARD_REG_SET reg_used_in_insn;
4175
4176 /* Mark reg REGNO as in use for a reload of the sort spec'd by OPNUM and
4177 TYPE. MODE is used to indicate how many consecutive regs are
4178 actually used. */
4179
4180 static void
4181 mark_reload_reg_in_use (regno, opnum, type, mode)
4182 unsigned int regno;
4183 int opnum;
4184 enum reload_type type;
4185 enum machine_mode mode;
4186 {
4187 unsigned int nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode);
4188 unsigned int i;
4189
4190 for (i = regno; i < nregs + regno; i++)
4191 {
4192 switch (type)
4193 {
4194 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4195 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, i);
4196 break;
4197
4198 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4199 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum], i);
4200 break;
4201
4202 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4203 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], i);
4204 break;
4205
4206 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4207 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum], i);
4208 break;
4209
4210 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4211 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum], i);
4212 break;
4213
4214 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4215 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, i);
4216 break;
4217
4218 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4219 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, i);
4220 break;
4221
4222 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4223 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, i);
4224 break;
4225
4226 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4227 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[opnum], i);
4228 break;
4229
4230 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4231 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[opnum], i);
4232 break;
4233
4234 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4235 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, i);
4236 break;
4237 }
4238
4239 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all, i);
4240 }
4241 }
4242
4243 /* Similarly, but show REGNO is no longer in use for a reload. */
4244
4245 static void
4246 clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno, opnum, type, mode)
4247 unsigned int regno;
4248 int opnum;
4249 enum reload_type type;
4250 enum machine_mode mode;
4251 {
4252 unsigned int nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode);
4253 unsigned int start_regno, end_regno, r;
4254 int i;
4255 /* A complication is that for some reload types, inheritance might
4256 allow multiple reloads of the same types to share a reload register.
4257 We set check_opnum if we have to check only reloads with the same
4258 operand number, and check_any if we have to check all reloads. */
4259 int check_opnum = 0;
4260 int check_any = 0;
4261 HARD_REG_SET *used_in_set;
4262
4263 switch (type)
4264 {
4265 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4266 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used;
4267 break;
4268
4269 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4270 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum];
4271 break;
4272
4273 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4274 check_opnum = 1;
4275 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum];
4276 break;
4277
4278 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4279 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum];
4280 break;
4281
4282 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4283 check_opnum = 1;
4284 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum];
4285 break;
4286
4287 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4288 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_op_addr;
4289 break;
4290
4291 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4292 check_any = 1;
4293 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload;
4294 break;
4295
4296 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4297 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_other_addr;
4298 check_any = 1;
4299 break;
4300
4301 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4302 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_input[opnum];
4303 break;
4304
4305 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4306 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_output[opnum];
4307 break;
4308
4309 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4310 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_insn;
4311 break;
4312 default:
4313 abort ();
4314 }
4315 /* We resolve conflicts with remaining reloads of the same type by
4316 excluding the intervals of of reload registers by them from the
4317 interval of freed reload registers. Since we only keep track of
4318 one set of interval bounds, we might have to exclude somewhat
4319 more then what would be necessary if we used a HARD_REG_SET here.
4320 But this should only happen very infrequently, so there should
4321 be no reason to worry about it. */
4322
4323 start_regno = regno;
4324 end_regno = regno + nregs;
4325 if (check_opnum || check_any)
4326 {
4327 for (i = n_reloads - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4328 {
4329 if (rld[i].when_needed == type
4330 && (check_any || rld[i].opnum == opnum)
4331 && rld[i].reg_rtx)
4332 {
4333 unsigned int conflict_start = true_regnum (rld[i].reg_rtx);
4334 unsigned int conflict_end
4335 = (conflict_start
4336 + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (conflict_start, rld[i].mode));
4337
4338 /* If there is an overlap with the first to-be-freed register,
4339 adjust the interval start. */
4340 if (conflict_start <= start_regno && conflict_end > start_regno)
4341 start_regno = conflict_end;
4342 /* Otherwise, if there is a conflict with one of the other
4343 to-be-freed registers, adjust the interval end. */
4344 if (conflict_start > start_regno && conflict_start < end_regno)
4345 end_regno = conflict_start;
4346 }
4347 }
4348 }
4349
4350 for (r = start_regno; r < end_regno; r++)
4351 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (*used_in_set, r);
4352 }
4353
4354 /* 1 if reg REGNO is free as a reload reg for a reload of the sort
4355 specified by OPNUM and TYPE. */
4356
4357 static int
4358 reload_reg_free_p (regno, opnum, type)
4359 unsigned int regno;
4360 int opnum;
4361 enum reload_type type;
4362 {
4363 int i;
4364
4365 /* In use for a RELOAD_OTHER means it's not available for anything. */
4366 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno)
4367 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable, regno))
4368 return 0;
4369
4370 switch (type)
4371 {
4372 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4373 /* In use for anything means we can't use it for RELOAD_OTHER. */
4374 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno)
4375 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
4376 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno))
4377 return 0;
4378
4379 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4380 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4381 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
4382 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4383 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4384 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno)
4385 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4386 return 0;
4387
4388 return 1;
4389
4390 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4391 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4392 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno))
4393 return 0;
4394
4395 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno))
4396 return 0;
4397
4398 /* If it is used for some other input, can't use it. */
4399 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4400 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4401 return 0;
4402
4403 /* If it is used in a later operand's address, can't use it. */
4404 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4405 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4406 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno))
4407 return 0;
4408
4409 return 1;
4410
4411 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4412 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an input address for this
4413 operand or used as an input in an earlier one. */
4414 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum], regno)
4415 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
4416 return 0;
4417
4418 for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
4419 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4420 return 0;
4421
4422 return 1;
4423
4424 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4425 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an input address
4426 for this operand or used as an input in an earlier
4427 one. */
4428 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
4429 return 0;
4430
4431 for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
4432 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4433 return 0;
4434
4435 return 1;
4436
4437 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4438 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an output address for this
4439 operand or used as an output in this or a later operand. */
4440 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum], regno))
4441 return 0;
4442
4443 for (i = opnum; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4444 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4445 return 0;
4446
4447 return 1;
4448
4449 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4450 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an output address
4451 for this operand or used as an output in this or a
4452 later operand. */
4453 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
4454 return 0;
4455
4456 for (i = opnum; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4457 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4458 return 0;
4459
4460 return 1;
4461
4462 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4463 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4464 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4465 return 0;
4466
4467 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4468 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno));
4469
4470 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4471 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4472 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4473 return 0;
4474
4475 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno));
4476
4477 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4478 /* This cannot share a register with RELOAD_FOR_INSN reloads, other
4479 outputs, or an operand address for this or an earlier output. */
4480 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno))
4481 return 0;
4482
4483 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4484 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4485 return 0;
4486
4487 for (i = 0; i <= opnum; i++)
4488 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4489 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno))
4490 return 0;
4491
4492 return 1;
4493
4494 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4495 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4496 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno)
4497 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4498 return 0;
4499
4500 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4501 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno));
4502
4503 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4504 return ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno);
4505 }
4506 abort ();
4507 }
4508
4509 /* Return 1 if the value in reload reg REGNO, as used by a reload
4510 needed for the part of the insn specified by OPNUM and TYPE,
4511 is still available in REGNO at the end of the insn.
4512
4513 We can assume that the reload reg was already tested for availability
4514 at the time it is needed, and we should not check this again,
4515 in case the reg has already been marked in use. */
4516
4517 static int
4518 reload_reg_reaches_end_p (regno, opnum, type)
4519 unsigned int regno;
4520 int opnum;
4521 enum reload_type type;
4522 {
4523 int i;
4524
4525 switch (type)
4526 {
4527 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4528 /* Since a RELOAD_OTHER reload claims the reg for the entire insn,
4529 its value must reach the end. */
4530 return 1;
4531
4532 /* If this use is for part of the insn,
4533 its value reaches if no subsequent part uses the same register.
4534 Just like the above function, don't try to do this with lots
4535 of fallthroughs. */
4536
4537 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4538 /* Here we check for everything else, since these don't conflict
4539 with anything else and everything comes later. */
4540
4541 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4542 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4543 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4544 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno)
4545 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4546 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
4547 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4548 return 0;
4549
4550 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
4551 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4552 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
4553
4554 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4555 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4556 /* Similar, except that we check only for this and subsequent inputs
4557 and the address of only subsequent inputs and we do not need
4558 to check for RELOAD_OTHER objects since they are known not to
4559 conflict. */
4560
4561 for (i = opnum; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4562 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4563 return 0;
4564
4565 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4566 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4567 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno))
4568 return 0;
4569
4570 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4571 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4572 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4573 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4574 return 0;
4575
4576 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno))
4577 return 0;
4578
4579 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
4580 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4581 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
4582
4583 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4584 /* Similar to input address, except we start at the next operand for
4585 both input and input address and we do not check for
4586 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_INSN since these
4587 would conflict. */
4588
4589 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4590 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4591 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
4592 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4593 return 0;
4594
4595 /* ... fall through ... */
4596
4597 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4598 /* Check outputs and their addresses. */
4599
4600 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4601 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4602 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4603 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4604 return 0;
4605
4606 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
4607
4608 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4609 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4610 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4611 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4612 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4613 return 0;
4614
4615 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
4616 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4617 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
4618
4619 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4620 /* These conflict with other outputs with RELOAD_OTHER. So
4621 we need only check for output addresses. */
4622
4623 opnum = -1;
4624
4625 /* ... fall through ... */
4626
4627 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4628 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4629 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4630 /* We already know these can't conflict with a later output. So the
4631 only thing to check are later output addresses. */
4632 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4633 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4634 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno))
4635 return 0;
4636
4637 return 1;
4638 }
4639
4640 abort ();
4641 }
4642 \f
4643 /* Return 1 if the reloads denoted by R1 and R2 cannot share a register.
4644 Return 0 otherwise.
4645
4646 This function uses the same algorithm as reload_reg_free_p above. */
4647
4648 int
4649 reloads_conflict (r1, r2)
4650 int r1, r2;
4651 {
4652 enum reload_type r1_type = rld[r1].when_needed;
4653 enum reload_type r2_type = rld[r2].when_needed;
4654 int r1_opnum = rld[r1].opnum;
4655 int r2_opnum = rld[r2].opnum;
4656
4657 /* RELOAD_OTHER conflicts with everything. */
4658 if (r2_type == RELOAD_OTHER)
4659 return 1;
4660
4661 /* Otherwise, check conflicts differently for each type. */
4662
4663 switch (r1_type)
4664 {
4665 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4666 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
4667 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
4668 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
4669 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
4670 || ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
4671 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS)
4672 && r2_opnum > r1_opnum));
4673
4674 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4675 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS && r1_opnum == r2_opnum)
4676 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && r2_opnum < r1_opnum));
4677
4678 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4679 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS && r1_opnum == r2_opnum)
4680 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && r2_opnum < r1_opnum));
4681
4682 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4683 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS && r2_opnum == r1_opnum)
4684 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT && r2_opnum >= r1_opnum));
4685
4686 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4687 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS && r2_opnum == r1_opnum)
4688 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT && r2_opnum >= r1_opnum));
4689
4690 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4691 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
4692 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS);
4693
4694 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4695 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
4696 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR);
4697
4698 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4699 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
4700 || ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
4701 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS)
4702 && r2_opnum <= r1_opnum));
4703
4704 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4705 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
4706 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
4707 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS);
4708
4709 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4710 return r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS;
4711
4712 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4713 return 1;
4714
4715 default:
4716 abort ();
4717 }
4718 }
4719 \f
4720 /* Indexed by reload number, 1 if incoming value
4721 inherited from previous insns. */
4722 char reload_inherited[MAX_RELOADS];
4723
4724 /* For an inherited reload, this is the insn the reload was inherited from,
4725 if we know it. Otherwise, this is 0. */
4726 rtx reload_inheritance_insn[MAX_RELOADS];
4727
4728 /* If non-zero, this is a place to get the value of the reload,
4729 rather than using reload_in. */
4730 rtx reload_override_in[MAX_RELOADS];
4731
4732 /* For each reload, the hard register number of the register used,
4733 or -1 if we did not need a register for this reload. */
4734 int reload_spill_index[MAX_RELOADS];
4735
4736 /* Subroutine of free_for_value_p, used to check a single register.
4737 START_REGNO is the starting regno of the full reload register
4738 (possibly comprising multiple hard registers) that we are considering. */
4739
4740 static int
4741 reload_reg_free_for_value_p (start_regno, regno, opnum, type, value, out,
4742 reloadnum, ignore_address_reloads)
4743 int start_regno, regno;
4744 int opnum;
4745 enum reload_type type;
4746 rtx value, out;
4747 int reloadnum;
4748 int ignore_address_reloads;
4749 {
4750 int time1;
4751 /* Set if we see an input reload that must not share its reload register
4752 with any new earlyclobber, but might otherwise share the reload
4753 register with an output or input-output reload. */
4754 int check_earlyclobber = 0;
4755 int i;
4756 int copy = 0;
4757
4758 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable, regno))
4759 return 0;
4760
4761 if (out == const0_rtx)
4762 {
4763 copy = 1;
4764 out = NULL_RTX;
4765 }
4766
4767 /* We use some pseudo 'time' value to check if the lifetimes of the
4768 new register use would overlap with the one of a previous reload
4769 that is not read-only or uses a different value.
4770 The 'time' used doesn't have to be linear in any shape or form, just
4771 monotonic.
4772 Some reload types use different 'buckets' for each operand.
4773 So there are MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS different time values for each
4774 such reload type.
4775 We compute TIME1 as the time when the register for the prospective
4776 new reload ceases to be live, and TIME2 for each existing
4777 reload as the time when that the reload register of that reload
4778 becomes live.
4779 Where there is little to be gained by exact lifetime calculations,
4780 we just make conservative assumptions, i.e. a longer lifetime;
4781 this is done in the 'default:' cases. */
4782 switch (type)
4783 {
4784 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4785 /* RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS conflicts with RELOAD_OTHER reloads. */
4786 time1 = copy ? 0 : 1;
4787 break;
4788 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4789 time1 = copy ? 1 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 5 + 5;
4790 break;
4791 /* For each input, we may have a sequence of RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS,
4792 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_INPUT. By adding 0 / 1 / 2 ,
4793 respectively, to the time values for these, we get distinct time
4794 values. To get distinct time values for each operand, we have to
4795 multiply opnum by at least three. We round that up to four because
4796 multiply by four is often cheaper. */
4797 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4798 time1 = opnum * 4 + 2;
4799 break;
4800 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4801 time1 = opnum * 4 + 3;
4802 break;
4803 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4804 /* All RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reloads remain live till the instruction
4805 executes (inclusive). */
4806 time1 = copy ? opnum * 4 + 4 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
4807 break;
4808 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4809 /* opnum * 4 + 4
4810 <= (MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS - 1) * 4 + 4 == MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 */
4811 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 1;
4812 break;
4813 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4814 /* RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads are live even while the insn
4815 is executed. */
4816 time1 = copy ? MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 2 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
4817 break;
4818 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4819 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4 + opnum;
4820 break;
4821 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4822 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 5 + opnum;
4823 break;
4824 default:
4825 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 5 + 5;
4826 }
4827
4828 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
4829 {
4830 rtx reg = rld[i].reg_rtx;
4831 if (reg && GET_CODE (reg) == REG
4832 && ((unsigned) regno - true_regnum (reg)
4833 <= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO (reg), GET_MODE (reg)) - (unsigned)1)
4834 && i != reloadnum)
4835 {
4836 rtx other_input = rld[i].in;
4837
4838 /* If the other reload loads the same input value, that
4839 will not cause a conflict only if it's loading it into
4840 the same register. */
4841 if (true_regnum (reg) != start_regno)
4842 other_input = NULL_RTX;
4843 if (! other_input || ! rtx_equal_p (other_input, value)
4844 || rld[i].out || out)
4845 {
4846 int time2;
4847 switch (rld[i].when_needed)
4848 {
4849 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4850 time2 = 0;
4851 break;
4852 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4853 /* find_reloads makes sure that a
4854 RELOAD_FOR_{INP,OP,OUT}ADDR_ADDRESS reload is only used
4855 by at most one - the first -
4856 RELOAD_FOR_{INPUT,OPERAND,OUTPUT}_ADDRESS . If the
4857 address reload is inherited, the address address reload
4858 goes away, so we can ignore this conflict. */
4859 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
4860 && ignore_address_reloads
4861 /* Unless the RELOAD_FOR_INPUT is an auto_inc expression.
4862 Then the address address is still needed to store
4863 back the new address. */
4864 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
4865 continue;
4866 /* Likewise, if a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT can inherit a value, its
4867 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS / RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
4868 reloads go away. */
4869 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && opnum == rld[i].opnum
4870 && ignore_address_reloads
4871 /* Unless we are reloading an auto_inc expression. */
4872 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
4873 continue;
4874 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 2;
4875 break;
4876 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4877 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && opnum == rld[i].opnum
4878 && ignore_address_reloads
4879 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
4880 continue;
4881 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 3;
4882 break;
4883 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4884 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 4;
4885 check_earlyclobber = 1;
4886 break;
4887 /* rld[i].opnum * 4 + 4 <= (MAX_RECOG_OPERAND - 1) * 4 + 4
4888 == MAX_RECOG_OPERAND * 4 */
4889 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4890 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
4891 && ignore_address_reloads
4892 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
4893 continue;
4894 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 1;
4895 break;
4896 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4897 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 2;
4898 check_earlyclobber = 1;
4899 break;
4900 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4901 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
4902 break;
4903 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4904 /* All RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reloads become live just after the
4905 instruction is executed. */
4906 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4;
4907 break;
4908 /* The first RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reload conflicts with
4909 the RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reloads, so assign it the same time
4910 value. */
4911 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4912 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
4913 && ignore_address_reloads
4914 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
4915 continue;
4916 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4 + rld[i].opnum;
4917 break;
4918 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4919 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 5 + rld[i].opnum;
4920 break;
4921 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4922 /* If there is no conflict in the input part, handle this
4923 like an output reload. */
4924 if (! rld[i].in || rtx_equal_p (other_input, value))
4925 {
4926 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4;
4927 /* Earlyclobbered outputs must conflict with inputs. */
4928 if (earlyclobber_operand_p (rld[i].out))
4929 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
4930
4931 break;
4932 }
4933 time2 = 1;
4934 /* RELOAD_OTHER might be live beyond instruction execution,
4935 but this is not obvious when we set time2 = 1. So check
4936 here if there might be a problem with the new reload
4937 clobbering the register used by the RELOAD_OTHER. */
4938 if (out)
4939 return 0;
4940 break;
4941 default:
4942 return 0;
4943 }
4944 if ((time1 >= time2
4945 && (! rld[i].in || rld[i].out
4946 || ! rtx_equal_p (other_input, value)))
4947 || (out && rld[reloadnum].out_reg
4948 && time2 >= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3))
4949 return 0;
4950 }
4951 }
4952 }
4953
4954 /* Earlyclobbered outputs must conflict with inputs. */
4955 if (check_earlyclobber && out && earlyclobber_operand_p (out))
4956 return 0;
4957
4958 return 1;
4959 }
4960
4961 /* Return 1 if the value in reload reg REGNO, as used by a reload
4962 needed for the part of the insn specified by OPNUM and TYPE,
4963 may be used to load VALUE into it.
4964
4965 MODE is the mode in which the register is used, this is needed to
4966 determine how many hard regs to test.
4967
4968 Other read-only reloads with the same value do not conflict
4969 unless OUT is non-zero and these other reloads have to live while
4970 output reloads live.
4971 If OUT is CONST0_RTX, this is a special case: it means that the
4972 test should not be for using register REGNO as reload register, but
4973 for copying from register REGNO into the reload register.
4974
4975 RELOADNUM is the number of the reload we want to load this value for;
4976 a reload does not conflict with itself.
4977
4978 When IGNORE_ADDRESS_RELOADS is set, we can not have conflicts with
4979 reloads that load an address for the very reload we are considering.
4980
4981 The caller has to make sure that there is no conflict with the return
4982 register. */
4983
4984 static int
4985 free_for_value_p (regno, mode, opnum, type, value, out, reloadnum,
4986 ignore_address_reloads)
4987 int regno;
4988 enum machine_mode mode;
4989 int opnum;
4990 enum reload_type type;
4991 rtx value, out;
4992 int reloadnum;
4993 int ignore_address_reloads;
4994 {
4995 int nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode);
4996 while (nregs-- > 0)
4997 if (! reload_reg_free_for_value_p (regno, regno + nregs, opnum, type,
4998 value, out, reloadnum,
4999 ignore_address_reloads))
5000 return 0;
5001 return 1;
5002 }
5003
5004 /* Determine whether the reload reg X overlaps any rtx'es used for
5005 overriding inheritance. Return nonzero if so. */
5006
5007 static int
5008 conflicts_with_override (x)
5009 rtx x;
5010 {
5011 int i;
5012 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5013 if (reload_override_in[i]
5014 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, reload_override_in[i]))
5015 return 1;
5016 return 0;
5017 }
5018 \f
5019 /* Give an error message saying we failed to find a reload for INSN,
5020 and clear out reload R. */
5021 static void
5022 failed_reload (insn, r)
5023 rtx insn;
5024 int r;
5025 {
5026 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) < 0)
5027 /* It's the compiler's fault. */
5028 fatal_insn ("Could not find a spill register", insn);
5029
5030 /* It's the user's fault; the operand's mode and constraint
5031 don't match. Disable this reload so we don't crash in final. */
5032 error_for_asm (insn,
5033 "`asm' operand constraint incompatible with operand size");
5034 rld[r].in = 0;
5035 rld[r].out = 0;
5036 rld[r].reg_rtx = 0;
5037 rld[r].optional = 1;
5038 rld[r].secondary_p = 1;
5039 }
5040
5041 /* I is the index in SPILL_REG_RTX of the reload register we are to allocate
5042 for reload R. If it's valid, get an rtx for it. Return nonzero if
5043 successful. */
5044 static int
5045 set_reload_reg (i, r)
5046 int i, r;
5047 {
5048 int regno;
5049 rtx reg = spill_reg_rtx[i];
5050
5051 if (reg == 0 || GET_MODE (reg) != rld[r].mode)
5052 spill_reg_rtx[i] = reg
5053 = gen_rtx_REG (rld[r].mode, spill_regs[i]);
5054
5055 regno = true_regnum (reg);
5056
5057 /* Detect when the reload reg can't hold the reload mode.
5058 This used to be one `if', but Sequent compiler can't handle that. */
5059 if (HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rld[r].mode))
5060 {
5061 enum machine_mode test_mode = VOIDmode;
5062 if (rld[r].in)
5063 test_mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in);
5064 /* If rld[r].in has VOIDmode, it means we will load it
5065 in whatever mode the reload reg has: to wit, rld[r].mode.
5066 We have already tested that for validity. */
5067 /* Aside from that, we need to test that the expressions
5068 to reload from or into have modes which are valid for this
5069 reload register. Otherwise the reload insns would be invalid. */
5070 if (! (rld[r].in != 0 && test_mode != VOIDmode
5071 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, test_mode)))
5072 if (! (rld[r].out != 0
5073 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, GET_MODE (rld[r].out))))
5074 {
5075 /* The reg is OK. */
5076 last_spill_reg = i;
5077
5078 /* Mark as in use for this insn the reload regs we use
5079 for this. */
5080 mark_reload_reg_in_use (spill_regs[i], rld[r].opnum,
5081 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].mode);
5082
5083 rld[r].reg_rtx = reg;
5084 reload_spill_index[r] = spill_regs[i];
5085 return 1;
5086 }
5087 }
5088 return 0;
5089 }
5090
5091 /* Find a spill register to use as a reload register for reload R.
5092 LAST_RELOAD is non-zero if this is the last reload for the insn being
5093 processed.
5094
5095 Set rld[R].reg_rtx to the register allocated.
5096
5097 We return 1 if successful, or 0 if we couldn't find a spill reg and
5098 we didn't change anything. */
5099
5100 static int
5101 allocate_reload_reg (chain, r, last_reload)
5102 struct insn_chain *chain ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
5103 int r;
5104 int last_reload;
5105 {
5106 int i, pass, count;
5107
5108 /* If we put this reload ahead, thinking it is a group,
5109 then insist on finding a group. Otherwise we can grab a
5110 reg that some other reload needs.
5111 (That can happen when we have a 68000 DATA_OR_FP_REG
5112 which is a group of data regs or one fp reg.)
5113 We need not be so restrictive if there are no more reloads
5114 for this insn.
5115
5116 ??? Really it would be nicer to have smarter handling
5117 for that kind of reg class, where a problem like this is normal.
5118 Perhaps those classes should be avoided for reloading
5119 by use of more alternatives. */
5120
5121 int force_group = rld[r].nregs > 1 && ! last_reload;
5122
5123 /* If we want a single register and haven't yet found one,
5124 take any reg in the right class and not in use.
5125 If we want a consecutive group, here is where we look for it.
5126
5127 We use two passes so we can first look for reload regs to
5128 reuse, which are already in use for other reloads in this insn,
5129 and only then use additional registers.
5130 I think that maximizing reuse is needed to make sure we don't
5131 run out of reload regs. Suppose we have three reloads, and
5132 reloads A and B can share regs. These need two regs.
5133 Suppose A and B are given different regs.
5134 That leaves none for C. */
5135 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; pass++)
5136 {
5137 /* I is the index in spill_regs.
5138 We advance it round-robin between insns to use all spill regs
5139 equally, so that inherited reloads have a chance
5140 of leapfrogging each other. */
5141
5142 i = last_spill_reg;
5143
5144 for (count = 0; count < n_spills; count++)
5145 {
5146 int class = (int) rld[r].class;
5147 int regnum;
5148
5149 i++;
5150 if (i >= n_spills)
5151 i -= n_spills;
5152 regnum = spill_regs[i];
5153
5154 if ((reload_reg_free_p (regnum, rld[r].opnum,
5155 rld[r].when_needed)
5156 || (rld[r].in
5157 /* We check reload_reg_used to make sure we
5158 don't clobber the return register. */
5159 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regnum)
5160 && free_for_value_p (regnum, rld[r].mode, rld[r].opnum,
5161 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
5162 rld[r].out, r, 1)))
5163 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], regnum)
5164 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regnum, rld[r].mode)
5165 /* Look first for regs to share, then for unshared. But
5166 don't share regs used for inherited reloads; they are
5167 the ones we want to preserve. */
5168 && (pass
5169 || (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all,
5170 regnum)
5171 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
5172 regnum))))
5173 {
5174 int nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regnum, rld[r].mode);
5175 /* Avoid the problem where spilling a GENERAL_OR_FP_REG
5176 (on 68000) got us two FP regs. If NR is 1,
5177 we would reject both of them. */
5178 if (force_group)
5179 nr = rld[r].nregs;
5180 /* If we need only one reg, we have already won. */
5181 if (nr == 1)
5182 {
5183 /* But reject a single reg if we demand a group. */
5184 if (force_group)
5185 continue;
5186 break;
5187 }
5188 /* Otherwise check that as many consecutive regs as we need
5189 are available here. */
5190 while (nr > 1)
5191 {
5192 int regno = regnum + nr - 1;
5193 if (!(TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], regno)
5194 && spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0
5195 && reload_reg_free_p (regno, rld[r].opnum,
5196 rld[r].when_needed)))
5197 break;
5198 nr--;
5199 }
5200 if (nr == 1)
5201 break;
5202 }
5203 }
5204
5205 /* If we found something on pass 1, omit pass 2. */
5206 if (count < n_spills)
5207 break;
5208 }
5209
5210 /* We should have found a spill register by now. */
5211 if (count >= n_spills)
5212 return 0;
5213
5214 /* I is the index in SPILL_REG_RTX of the reload register we are to
5215 allocate. Get an rtx for it and find its register number. */
5216
5217 return set_reload_reg (i, r);
5218 }
5219 \f
5220 /* Initialize all the tables needed to allocate reload registers.
5221 CHAIN is the insn currently being processed; SAVE_RELOAD_REG_RTX
5222 is the array we use to restore the reg_rtx field for every reload. */
5223
5224 static void
5225 choose_reload_regs_init (chain, save_reload_reg_rtx)
5226 struct insn_chain *chain;
5227 rtx *save_reload_reg_rtx;
5228 {
5229 int i;
5230
5231 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5232 rld[i].reg_rtx = save_reload_reg_rtx[i];
5233
5234 memset (reload_inherited, 0, MAX_RELOADS);
5235 memset ((char *) reload_inheritance_insn, 0, MAX_RELOADS * sizeof (rtx));
5236 memset ((char *) reload_override_in, 0, MAX_RELOADS * sizeof (rtx));
5237
5238 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used);
5239 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_at_all);
5240 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr);
5241 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload);
5242 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_insn);
5243 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr);
5244
5245 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn);
5246 {
5247 HARD_REG_SET tmp;
5248 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (tmp, &chain->live_throughout);
5249 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn, tmp);
5250 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (tmp, &chain->dead_or_set);
5251 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn, tmp);
5252 compute_use_by_pseudos (&reg_used_in_insn, &chain->live_throughout);
5253 compute_use_by_pseudos (&reg_used_in_insn, &chain->dead_or_set);
5254 }
5255
5256 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5257 {
5258 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output[i]);
5259 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input[i]);
5260 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i]);
5261 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i]);
5262 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i]);
5263 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i]);
5264 }
5265
5266 COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_unavailable, chain->used_spill_regs);
5267
5268 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_for_inherit);
5269
5270 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5271 /* If we have already decided to use a certain register,
5272 don't use it in another way. */
5273 if (rld[i].reg_rtx)
5274 mark_reload_reg_in_use (REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx), rld[i].opnum,
5275 rld[i].when_needed, rld[i].mode);
5276 }
5277
5278 /* Assign hard reg targets for the pseudo-registers we must reload
5279 into hard regs for this insn.
5280 Also output the instructions to copy them in and out of the hard regs.
5281
5282 For machines with register classes, we are responsible for
5283 finding a reload reg in the proper class. */
5284
5285 static void
5286 choose_reload_regs (chain)
5287 struct insn_chain *chain;
5288 {
5289 rtx insn = chain->insn;
5290 register int i, j;
5291 unsigned int max_group_size = 1;
5292 enum reg_class group_class = NO_REGS;
5293 int pass, win, inheritance;
5294
5295 rtx save_reload_reg_rtx[MAX_RELOADS];
5296
5297 /* In order to be certain of getting the registers we need,
5298 we must sort the reloads into order of increasing register class.
5299 Then our grabbing of reload registers will parallel the process
5300 that provided the reload registers.
5301
5302 Also note whether any of the reloads wants a consecutive group of regs.
5303 If so, record the maximum size of the group desired and what
5304 register class contains all the groups needed by this insn. */
5305
5306 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5307 {
5308 reload_order[j] = j;
5309 reload_spill_index[j] = -1;
5310
5311 if (rld[j].nregs > 1)
5312 {
5313 max_group_size = MAX (rld[j].nregs, max_group_size);
5314 group_class
5315 = reg_class_superunion[(int) rld[j].class][(int)group_class];
5316 }
5317
5318 save_reload_reg_rtx[j] = rld[j].reg_rtx;
5319 }
5320
5321 if (n_reloads > 1)
5322 qsort (reload_order, n_reloads, sizeof (short), reload_reg_class_lower);
5323
5324 /* If -O, try first with inheritance, then turning it off.
5325 If not -O, don't do inheritance.
5326 Using inheritance when not optimizing leads to paradoxes
5327 with fp on the 68k: fp numbers (not NaNs) fail to be equal to themselves
5328 because one side of the comparison might be inherited. */
5329 win = 0;
5330 for (inheritance = optimize > 0; inheritance >= 0; inheritance--)
5331 {
5332 choose_reload_regs_init (chain, save_reload_reg_rtx);
5333
5334 /* Process the reloads in order of preference just found.
5335 Beyond this point, subregs can be found in reload_reg_rtx.
5336
5337 This used to look for an existing reloaded home for all of the
5338 reloads, and only then perform any new reloads. But that could lose
5339 if the reloads were done out of reg-class order because a later
5340 reload with a looser constraint might have an old home in a register
5341 needed by an earlier reload with a tighter constraint.
5342
5343 To solve this, we make two passes over the reloads, in the order
5344 described above. In the first pass we try to inherit a reload
5345 from a previous insn. If there is a later reload that needs a
5346 class that is a proper subset of the class being processed, we must
5347 also allocate a spill register during the first pass.
5348
5349 Then make a second pass over the reloads to allocate any reloads
5350 that haven't been given registers yet. */
5351
5352 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5353 {
5354 register int r = reload_order[j];
5355 rtx search_equiv = NULL_RTX;
5356
5357 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
5358 if (rld[r].out == 0 && rld[r].in == 0
5359 && ! rld[r].secondary_p)
5360 continue;
5361
5362 /* If find_reloads chose to use reload_in or reload_out as a reload
5363 register, we don't need to chose one. Otherwise, try even if it
5364 found one since we might save an insn if we find the value lying
5365 around.
5366 Try also when reload_in is a pseudo without a hard reg. */
5367 if (rld[r].in != 0 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0
5368 && (rtx_equal_p (rld[r].in, rld[r].reg_rtx)
5369 || (rtx_equal_p (rld[r].out, rld[r].reg_rtx)
5370 && GET_CODE (rld[r].in) != MEM
5371 && true_regnum (rld[r].in) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
5372 continue;
5373
5374 #if 0 /* No longer needed for correct operation.
5375 It might give better code, or might not; worth an experiment? */
5376 /* If this is an optional reload, we can't inherit from earlier insns
5377 until we are sure that any non-optional reloads have been allocated.
5378 The following code takes advantage of the fact that optional reloads
5379 are at the end of reload_order. */
5380 if (rld[r].optional != 0)
5381 for (i = 0; i < j; i++)
5382 if ((rld[reload_order[i]].out != 0
5383 || rld[reload_order[i]].in != 0
5384 || rld[reload_order[i]].secondary_p)
5385 && ! rld[reload_order[i]].optional
5386 && rld[reload_order[i]].reg_rtx == 0)
5387 allocate_reload_reg (chain, reload_order[i], 0);
5388 #endif
5389
5390 /* First see if this pseudo is already available as reloaded
5391 for a previous insn. We cannot try to inherit for reloads
5392 that are smaller than the maximum number of registers needed
5393 for groups unless the register we would allocate cannot be used
5394 for the groups.
5395
5396 We could check here to see if this is a secondary reload for
5397 an object that is already in a register of the desired class.
5398 This would avoid the need for the secondary reload register.
5399 But this is complex because we can't easily determine what
5400 objects might want to be loaded via this reload. So let a
5401 register be allocated here. In `emit_reload_insns' we suppress
5402 one of the loads in the case described above. */
5403
5404 if (inheritance)
5405 {
5406 int byte = 0;
5407 register int regno = -1;
5408 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
5409
5410 if (rld[r].in == 0)
5411 ;
5412 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == REG)
5413 {
5414 regno = REGNO (rld[r].in);
5415 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in);
5416 }
5417 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == REG)
5418 {
5419 regno = REGNO (rld[r].in_reg);
5420 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in_reg);
5421 }
5422 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == SUBREG
5423 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in_reg)) == REG)
5424 {
5425 byte = SUBREG_BYTE (rld[r].in_reg);
5426 regno = REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in_reg));
5427 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5428 regno = subreg_regno (rld[r].in_reg);
5429 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in_reg);
5430 }
5431 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
5432 else if ((GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == PRE_INC
5433 || GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == PRE_DEC
5434 || GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == POST_INC
5435 || GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == POST_DEC)
5436 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0)) == REG)
5437 {
5438 regno = REGNO (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
5439 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
5440 rld[r].out = rld[r].in;
5441 }
5442 #endif
5443 #if 0
5444 /* This won't work, since REGNO can be a pseudo reg number.
5445 Also, it takes much more hair to keep track of all the things
5446 that can invalidate an inherited reload of part of a pseudoreg. */
5447 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == SUBREG
5448 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in)) == REG)
5449 regno = subreg_regno (rld[r].in);
5450 #endif
5451
5452 if (regno >= 0 && reg_last_reload_reg[regno] != 0)
5453 {
5454 enum reg_class class = rld[r].class, last_class;
5455 rtx last_reg = reg_last_reload_reg[regno];
5456 enum machine_mode need_mode;
5457
5458 i = REGNO (last_reg);
5459 i += subreg_regno_offset (i, GET_MODE (last_reg), byte, mode);
5460 last_class = REGNO_REG_CLASS (i);
5461
5462 if (byte == 0)
5463 need_mode = mode;
5464 else
5465 need_mode
5466 = smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + byte,
5467 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode));
5468
5469 if (
5470 #ifdef CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE
5471 (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT
5472 (reg_class_contents[(int) CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE], i)
5473 ? ! CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P (GET_MODE (last_reg),
5474 need_mode)
5475 : (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (last_reg))
5476 >= GET_MODE_SIZE (need_mode)))
5477 #else
5478 (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (last_reg))
5479 >= GET_MODE_SIZE (need_mode))
5480 #endif
5481 && reg_reloaded_contents[i] == regno
5482 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i)
5483 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (i, rld[r].mode)
5484 && (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) class], i)
5485 /* Even if we can't use this register as a reload
5486 register, we might use it for reload_override_in,
5487 if copying it to the desired class is cheap
5488 enough. */
5489 || ((REGISTER_MOVE_COST (mode, last_class, class)
5490 < MEMORY_MOVE_COST (mode, class, 1))
5491 #ifdef SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
5492 && (SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (class, mode,
5493 last_reg)
5494 == NO_REGS)
5495 #endif
5496 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
5497 && ! SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (last_class, class,
5498 mode)
5499 #endif
5500 ))
5501
5502 && (rld[r].nregs == max_group_size
5503 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) group_class],
5504 i))
5505 && free_for_value_p (i, rld[r].mode, rld[r].opnum,
5506 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
5507 const0_rtx, r, 1))
5508 {
5509 /* If a group is needed, verify that all the subsequent
5510 registers still have their values intact. */
5511 int nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i, rld[r].mode);
5512 int k;
5513
5514 for (k = 1; k < nr; k++)
5515 if (reg_reloaded_contents[i + k] != regno
5516 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k))
5517 break;
5518
5519 if (k == nr)
5520 {
5521 int i1;
5522
5523 last_reg = (GET_MODE (last_reg) == mode
5524 ? last_reg : gen_rtx_REG (mode, i));
5525
5526 /* We found a register that contains the
5527 value we need. If this register is the
5528 same as an `earlyclobber' operand of the
5529 current insn, just mark it as a place to
5530 reload from since we can't use it as the
5531 reload register itself. */
5532
5533 for (i1 = 0; i1 < n_earlyclobbers; i1++)
5534 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p
5535 (reg_last_reload_reg[regno],
5536 reload_earlyclobbers[i1]))
5537 break;
5538
5539 if (i1 != n_earlyclobbers
5540 || ! (free_for_value_p (i, rld[r].mode,
5541 rld[r].opnum,
5542 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
5543 rld[r].out, r, 1))
5544 /* Don't use it if we'd clobber a pseudo reg. */
5545 || (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_used_in_insn, i)
5546 && rld[r].out
5547 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, i))
5548 /* Don't clobber the frame pointer. */
5549 || (i == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
5550 && rld[r].out)
5551 /* Don't really use the inherited spill reg
5552 if we need it wider than we've got it. */
5553 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (rld[r].mode)
5554 > GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
5555 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) rld[r].class],
5556 i)
5557
5558 /* If find_reloads chose reload_out as reload
5559 register, stay with it - that leaves the
5560 inherited register for subsequent reloads. */
5561 || (rld[r].out && rld[r].reg_rtx
5562 && rtx_equal_p (rld[r].out, rld[r].reg_rtx)))
5563 {
5564 if (! rld[r].optional)
5565 {
5566 reload_override_in[r] = last_reg;
5567 reload_inheritance_insn[r]
5568 = reg_reloaded_insn[i];
5569 }
5570 }
5571 else
5572 {
5573 int k;
5574 /* We can use this as a reload reg. */
5575 /* Mark the register as in use for this part of
5576 the insn. */
5577 mark_reload_reg_in_use (i,
5578 rld[r].opnum,
5579 rld[r].when_needed,
5580 rld[r].mode);
5581 rld[r].reg_rtx = last_reg;
5582 reload_inherited[r] = 1;
5583 reload_inheritance_insn[r]
5584 = reg_reloaded_insn[i];
5585 reload_spill_index[r] = i;
5586 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
5587 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
5588 i + k);
5589 }
5590 }
5591 }
5592 }
5593 }
5594
5595 /* Here's another way to see if the value is already lying around. */
5596 if (inheritance
5597 && rld[r].in != 0
5598 && ! reload_inherited[r]
5599 && rld[r].out == 0
5600 && (CONSTANT_P (rld[r].in)
5601 || GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == PLUS
5602 || GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == REG
5603 || GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == MEM)
5604 && (rld[r].nregs == max_group_size
5605 || ! reg_classes_intersect_p (rld[r].class, group_class)))
5606 search_equiv = rld[r].in;
5607 /* If this is an output reload from a simple move insn, look
5608 if an equivalence for the input is available. */
5609 else if (inheritance && rld[r].in == 0 && rld[r].out != 0)
5610 {
5611 rtx set = single_set (insn);
5612
5613 if (set
5614 && rtx_equal_p (rld[r].out, SET_DEST (set))
5615 && CONSTANT_P (SET_SRC (set)))
5616 search_equiv = SET_SRC (set);
5617 }
5618
5619 if (search_equiv)
5620 {
5621 register rtx equiv
5622 = find_equiv_reg (search_equiv, insn, rld[r].class,
5623 -1, NULL, 0, rld[r].mode);
5624 int regno = 0;
5625
5626 if (equiv != 0)
5627 {
5628 if (GET_CODE (equiv) == REG)
5629 regno = REGNO (equiv);
5630 else if (GET_CODE (equiv) == SUBREG)
5631 {
5632 /* This must be a SUBREG of a hard register.
5633 Make a new REG since this might be used in an
5634 address and not all machines support SUBREGs
5635 there. */
5636 regno = subreg_regno (equiv);
5637 equiv = gen_rtx_REG (rld[r].mode, regno);
5638 }
5639 else
5640 abort ();
5641 }
5642
5643 /* If we found a spill reg, reject it unless it is free
5644 and of the desired class. */
5645 if (equiv != 0
5646 && ((TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all, regno)
5647 && ! free_for_value_p (regno, rld[r].mode,
5648 rld[r].opnum, rld[r].when_needed,
5649 rld[r].in, rld[r].out, r, 1))
5650 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) rld[r].class],
5651 regno)))
5652 equiv = 0;
5653
5654 if (equiv != 0 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rld[r].mode))
5655 equiv = 0;
5656
5657 /* We found a register that contains the value we need.
5658 If this register is the same as an `earlyclobber' operand
5659 of the current insn, just mark it as a place to reload from
5660 since we can't use it as the reload register itself. */
5661
5662 if (equiv != 0)
5663 for (i = 0; i < n_earlyclobbers; i++)
5664 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (equiv,
5665 reload_earlyclobbers[i]))
5666 {
5667 if (! rld[r].optional)
5668 reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
5669 equiv = 0;
5670 break;
5671 }
5672
5673 /* If the equiv register we have found is explicitly clobbered
5674 in the current insn, it depends on the reload type if we
5675 can use it, use it for reload_override_in, or not at all.
5676 In particular, we then can't use EQUIV for a
5677 RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload. */
5678
5679 if (equiv != 0)
5680 {
5681 if (regno_clobbered_p (regno, insn, rld[r].mode, 0))
5682 switch (rld[r].when_needed)
5683 {
5684 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5685 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5686 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5687 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5688 break;
5689 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5690 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5691 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5692 if (! rld[r].optional)
5693 reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
5694 /* Fall through. */
5695 default:
5696 equiv = 0;
5697 break;
5698 }
5699 else if (regno_clobbered_p (regno, insn, rld[r].mode, 1))
5700 switch (rld[r].when_needed)
5701 {
5702 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5703 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5704 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5705 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5706 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5707 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5708 break;
5709 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5710 if (! rld[r].optional)
5711 reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
5712 /* Fall through. */
5713 default:
5714 equiv = 0;
5715 break;
5716 }
5717 }
5718
5719 /* If we found an equivalent reg, say no code need be generated
5720 to load it, and use it as our reload reg. */
5721 if (equiv != 0 && regno != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
5722 {
5723 int nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, rld[r].mode);
5724 int k;
5725 rld[r].reg_rtx = equiv;
5726 reload_inherited[r] = 1;
5727
5728 /* If reg_reloaded_valid is not set for this register,
5729 there might be a stale spill_reg_store lying around.
5730 We must clear it, since otherwise emit_reload_insns
5731 might delete the store. */
5732 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno))
5733 spill_reg_store[regno] = NULL_RTX;
5734 /* If any of the hard registers in EQUIV are spill
5735 registers, mark them as in use for this insn. */
5736 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
5737 {
5738 i = spill_reg_order[regno + k];
5739 if (i >= 0)
5740 {
5741 mark_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[r].opnum,
5742 rld[r].when_needed,
5743 rld[r].mode);
5744 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
5745 regno + k);
5746 }
5747 }
5748 }
5749 }
5750
5751 /* If we found a register to use already, or if this is an optional
5752 reload, we are done. */
5753 if (rld[r].reg_rtx != 0 || rld[r].optional != 0)
5754 continue;
5755
5756 #if 0
5757 /* No longer needed for correct operation. Might or might
5758 not give better code on the average. Want to experiment? */
5759
5760 /* See if there is a later reload that has a class different from our
5761 class that intersects our class or that requires less register
5762 than our reload. If so, we must allocate a register to this
5763 reload now, since that reload might inherit a previous reload
5764 and take the only available register in our class. Don't do this
5765 for optional reloads since they will force all previous reloads
5766 to be allocated. Also don't do this for reloads that have been
5767 turned off. */
5768
5769 for (i = j + 1; i < n_reloads; i++)
5770 {
5771 int s = reload_order[i];
5772
5773 if ((rld[s].in == 0 && rld[s].out == 0
5774 && ! rld[s].secondary_p)
5775 || rld[s].optional)
5776 continue;
5777
5778 if ((rld[s].class != rld[r].class
5779 && reg_classes_intersect_p (rld[r].class,
5780 rld[s].class))
5781 || rld[s].nregs < rld[r].nregs)
5782 break;
5783 }
5784
5785 if (i == n_reloads)
5786 continue;
5787
5788 allocate_reload_reg (chain, r, j == n_reloads - 1);
5789 #endif
5790 }
5791
5792 /* Now allocate reload registers for anything non-optional that
5793 didn't get one yet. */
5794 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5795 {
5796 register int r = reload_order[j];
5797
5798 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
5799 if (rld[r].out == 0 && rld[r].in == 0 && ! rld[r].secondary_p)
5800 continue;
5801
5802 /* Skip reloads that already have a register allocated or are
5803 optional. */
5804 if (rld[r].reg_rtx != 0 || rld[r].optional)
5805 continue;
5806
5807 if (! allocate_reload_reg (chain, r, j == n_reloads - 1))
5808 break;
5809 }
5810
5811 /* If that loop got all the way, we have won. */
5812 if (j == n_reloads)
5813 {
5814 win = 1;
5815 break;
5816 }
5817
5818 /* Loop around and try without any inheritance. */
5819 }
5820
5821 if (! win)
5822 {
5823 /* First undo everything done by the failed attempt
5824 to allocate with inheritance. */
5825 choose_reload_regs_init (chain, save_reload_reg_rtx);
5826
5827 /* Some sanity tests to verify that the reloads found in the first
5828 pass are identical to the ones we have now. */
5829 if (chain->n_reloads != n_reloads)
5830 abort ();
5831
5832 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5833 {
5834 if (chain->rld[i].regno < 0 || chain->rld[i].reg_rtx != 0)
5835 continue;
5836 if (chain->rld[i].when_needed != rld[i].when_needed)
5837 abort ();
5838 for (j = 0; j < n_spills; j++)
5839 if (spill_regs[j] == chain->rld[i].regno)
5840 if (! set_reload_reg (j, i))
5841 failed_reload (chain->insn, i);
5842 }
5843 }
5844
5845 /* If we thought we could inherit a reload, because it seemed that
5846 nothing else wanted the same reload register earlier in the insn,
5847 verify that assumption, now that all reloads have been assigned.
5848 Likewise for reloads where reload_override_in has been set. */
5849
5850 /* If doing expensive optimizations, do one preliminary pass that doesn't
5851 cancel any inheritance, but removes reloads that have been needed only
5852 for reloads that we know can be inherited. */
5853 for (pass = flag_expensive_optimizations; pass >= 0; pass--)
5854 {
5855 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5856 {
5857 register int r = reload_order[j];
5858 rtx check_reg;
5859 if (reload_inherited[r] && rld[r].reg_rtx)
5860 check_reg = rld[r].reg_rtx;
5861 else if (reload_override_in[r]
5862 && (GET_CODE (reload_override_in[r]) == REG
5863 || GET_CODE (reload_override_in[r]) == SUBREG))
5864 check_reg = reload_override_in[r];
5865 else
5866 continue;
5867 if (! free_for_value_p (true_regnum (check_reg), rld[r].mode,
5868 rld[r].opnum, rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
5869 (reload_inherited[r]
5870 ? rld[r].out : const0_rtx),
5871 r, 1))
5872 {
5873 if (pass)
5874 continue;
5875 reload_inherited[r] = 0;
5876 reload_override_in[r] = 0;
5877 }
5878 /* If we can inherit a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT, or can use a
5879 reload_override_in, then we do not need its related
5880 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS / RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reloads;
5881 likewise for other reload types.
5882 We handle this by removing a reload when its only replacement
5883 is mentioned in reload_in of the reload we are going to inherit.
5884 A special case are auto_inc expressions; even if the input is
5885 inherited, we still need the address for the output. We can
5886 recognize them because they have RELOAD_OUT set to RELOAD_IN.
5887 If we suceeded removing some reload and we are doing a preliminary
5888 pass just to remove such reloads, make another pass, since the
5889 removal of one reload might allow us to inherit another one. */
5890 else if (rld[r].in
5891 && rld[r].out != rld[r].in
5892 && remove_address_replacements (rld[r].in) && pass)
5893 pass = 2;
5894 }
5895 }
5896
5897 /* Now that reload_override_in is known valid,
5898 actually override reload_in. */
5899 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5900 if (reload_override_in[j])
5901 rld[j].in = reload_override_in[j];
5902
5903 /* If this reload won't be done because it has been cancelled or is
5904 optional and not inherited, clear reload_reg_rtx so other
5905 routines (such as subst_reloads) don't get confused. */
5906 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5907 if (rld[j].reg_rtx != 0
5908 && ((rld[j].optional && ! reload_inherited[j])
5909 || (rld[j].in == 0 && rld[j].out == 0
5910 && ! rld[j].secondary_p)))
5911 {
5912 int regno = true_regnum (rld[j].reg_rtx);
5913
5914 if (spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0)
5915 clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[j].opnum,
5916 rld[j].when_needed, rld[j].mode);
5917 rld[j].reg_rtx = 0;
5918 reload_spill_index[j] = -1;
5919 }
5920
5921 /* Record which pseudos and which spill regs have output reloads. */
5922 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5923 {
5924 register int r = reload_order[j];
5925
5926 i = reload_spill_index[r];
5927
5928 /* I is nonneg if this reload uses a register.
5929 If rld[r].reg_rtx is 0, this is an optional reload
5930 that we opted to ignore. */
5931 if (rld[r].out_reg != 0 && GET_CODE (rld[r].out_reg) == REG
5932 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0)
5933 {
5934 register int nregno = REGNO (rld[r].out_reg);
5935 int nr = 1;
5936
5937 if (nregno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5938 nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (nregno, rld[r].mode);
5939
5940 while (--nr >= 0)
5941 reg_has_output_reload[nregno + nr] = 1;
5942
5943 if (i >= 0)
5944 {
5945 nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i, rld[r].mode);
5946 while (--nr >= 0)
5947 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, i + nr);
5948 }
5949
5950 if (rld[r].when_needed != RELOAD_OTHER
5951 && rld[r].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
5952 && rld[r].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_INSN)
5953 abort ();
5954 }
5955 }
5956 }
5957
5958 /* Deallocate the reload register for reload R. This is called from
5959 remove_address_replacements. */
5960
5961 void
5962 deallocate_reload_reg (r)
5963 int r;
5964 {
5965 int regno;
5966
5967 if (! rld[r].reg_rtx)
5968 return;
5969 regno = true_regnum (rld[r].reg_rtx);
5970 rld[r].reg_rtx = 0;
5971 if (spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0)
5972 clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[r].opnum, rld[r].when_needed,
5973 rld[r].mode);
5974 reload_spill_index[r] = -1;
5975 }
5976 \f
5977 /* If SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES is non-zero, we may not have merged two
5978 reloads of the same item for fear that we might not have enough reload
5979 registers. However, normally they will get the same reload register
5980 and hence actually need not be loaded twice.
5981
5982 Here we check for the most common case of this phenomenon: when we have
5983 a number of reloads for the same object, each of which were allocated
5984 the same reload_reg_rtx, that reload_reg_rtx is not used for any other
5985 reload, and is not modified in the insn itself. If we find such,
5986 merge all the reloads and set the resulting reload to RELOAD_OTHER.
5987 This will not increase the number of spill registers needed and will
5988 prevent redundant code. */
5989
5990 static void
5991 merge_assigned_reloads (insn)
5992 rtx insn;
5993 {
5994 int i, j;
5995
5996 /* Scan all the reloads looking for ones that only load values and
5997 are not already RELOAD_OTHER and ones whose reload_reg_rtx are
5998 assigned and not modified by INSN. */
5999
6000 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
6001 {
6002 int conflicting_input = 0;
6003 int max_input_address_opnum = -1;
6004 int min_conflicting_input_opnum = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS;
6005
6006 if (rld[i].in == 0 || rld[i].when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER
6007 || rld[i].out != 0 || rld[i].reg_rtx == 0
6008 || reg_set_p (rld[i].reg_rtx, insn))
6009 continue;
6010
6011 /* Look at all other reloads. Ensure that the only use of this
6012 reload_reg_rtx is in a reload that just loads the same value
6013 as we do. Note that any secondary reloads must be of the identical
6014 class since the values, modes, and result registers are the
6015 same, so we need not do anything with any secondary reloads. */
6016
6017 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6018 {
6019 if (i == j || rld[j].reg_rtx == 0
6020 || ! reg_overlap_mentioned_p (rld[j].reg_rtx,
6021 rld[i].reg_rtx))
6022 continue;
6023
6024 if (rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6025 && rld[j].opnum > max_input_address_opnum)
6026 max_input_address_opnum = rld[j].opnum;
6027
6028 /* If the reload regs aren't exactly the same (e.g, different modes)
6029 or if the values are different, we can't merge this reload.
6030 But if it is an input reload, we might still merge
6031 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reloads. */
6032
6033 if (! rtx_equal_p (rld[i].reg_rtx, rld[j].reg_rtx)
6034 || rld[j].out != 0 || rld[j].in == 0
6035 || ! rtx_equal_p (rld[i].in, rld[j].in))
6036 {
6037 if (rld[j].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
6038 || ((rld[i].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6039 || rld[i].opnum > rld[j].opnum)
6040 && rld[i].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS))
6041 break;
6042 conflicting_input = 1;
6043 if (min_conflicting_input_opnum > rld[j].opnum)
6044 min_conflicting_input_opnum = rld[j].opnum;
6045 }
6046 }
6047
6048 /* If all is OK, merge the reloads. Only set this to RELOAD_OTHER if
6049 we, in fact, found any matching reloads. */
6050
6051 if (j == n_reloads
6052 && max_input_address_opnum <= min_conflicting_input_opnum)
6053 {
6054 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6055 if (i != j && rld[j].reg_rtx != 0
6056 && rtx_equal_p (rld[i].reg_rtx, rld[j].reg_rtx)
6057 && (! conflicting_input
6058 || rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6059 || rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS))
6060 {
6061 rld[i].when_needed = RELOAD_OTHER;
6062 rld[j].in = 0;
6063 reload_spill_index[j] = -1;
6064 transfer_replacements (i, j);
6065 }
6066
6067 /* If this is now RELOAD_OTHER, look for any reloads that load
6068 parts of this operand and set them to RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
6069 if they were for inputs, RELOAD_OTHER for outputs. Note that
6070 this test is equivalent to looking for reloads for this operand
6071 number. */
6072
6073 if (rld[i].when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER)
6074 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6075 if (rld[j].in != 0
6076 && rld[i].when_needed != RELOAD_OTHER
6077 && reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (rld[j].in,
6078 rld[i].in))
6079 rld[j].when_needed
6080 = ((rld[i].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6081 || rld[i].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS)
6082 ? RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS : RELOAD_OTHER);
6083 }
6084 }
6085 }
6086 \f
6087 /* These arrays are filled by emit_reload_insns and its subroutines. */
6088 static rtx input_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6089 static rtx other_input_address_reload_insns = 0;
6090 static rtx other_input_reload_insns = 0;
6091 static rtx input_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6092 static rtx inpaddr_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6093 static rtx output_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6094 static rtx output_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6095 static rtx outaddr_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6096 static rtx operand_reload_insns = 0;
6097 static rtx other_operand_reload_insns = 0;
6098 static rtx other_output_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6099
6100 /* Values to be put in spill_reg_store are put here first. */
6101 static rtx new_spill_reg_store[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
6102 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_died;
6103
6104 /* Generate insns to perform reload RL, which is for the insn in CHAIN and
6105 has the number J. OLD contains the value to be used as input. */
6106
6107 static void
6108 emit_input_reload_insns (chain, rl, old, j)
6109 struct insn_chain *chain;
6110 struct reload *rl;
6111 rtx old;
6112 int j;
6113 {
6114 rtx insn = chain->insn;
6115 register rtx reloadreg = rl->reg_rtx;
6116 rtx oldequiv_reg = 0;
6117 rtx oldequiv = 0;
6118 int special = 0;
6119 enum machine_mode mode;
6120 rtx *where;
6121
6122 /* Determine the mode to reload in.
6123 This is very tricky because we have three to choose from.
6124 There is the mode the insn operand wants (rl->inmode).
6125 There is the mode of the reload register RELOADREG.
6126 There is the intrinsic mode of the operand, which we could find
6127 by stripping some SUBREGs.
6128 It turns out that RELOADREG's mode is irrelevant:
6129 we can change that arbitrarily.
6130
6131 Consider (SUBREG:SI foo:QI) as an operand that must be SImode;
6132 then the reload reg may not support QImode moves, so use SImode.
6133 If foo is in memory due to spilling a pseudo reg, this is safe,
6134 because the QImode value is in the least significant part of a
6135 slot big enough for a SImode. If foo is some other sort of
6136 memory reference, then it is impossible to reload this case,
6137 so previous passes had better make sure this never happens.
6138
6139 Then consider a one-word union which has SImode and one of its
6140 members is a float, being fetched as (SUBREG:SF union:SI).
6141 We must fetch that as SFmode because we could be loading into
6142 a float-only register. In this case OLD's mode is correct.
6143
6144 Consider an immediate integer: it has VOIDmode. Here we need
6145 to get a mode from something else.
6146
6147 In some cases, there is a fourth mode, the operand's
6148 containing mode. If the insn specifies a containing mode for
6149 this operand, it overrides all others.
6150
6151 I am not sure whether the algorithm here is always right,
6152 but it does the right things in those cases. */
6153
6154 mode = GET_MODE (old);
6155 if (mode == VOIDmode)
6156 mode = rl->inmode;
6157
6158 #ifdef SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
6159 /* If we need a secondary register for this operation, see if
6160 the value is already in a register in that class. Don't
6161 do this if the secondary register will be used as a scratch
6162 register. */
6163
6164 if (rl->secondary_in_reload >= 0
6165 && rl->secondary_in_icode == CODE_FOR_nothing
6166 && optimize)
6167 oldequiv
6168 = find_equiv_reg (old, insn,
6169 rld[rl->secondary_in_reload].class,
6170 -1, NULL, 0, mode);
6171 #endif
6172
6173 /* If reloading from memory, see if there is a register
6174 that already holds the same value. If so, reload from there.
6175 We can pass 0 as the reload_reg_p argument because
6176 any other reload has either already been emitted,
6177 in which case find_equiv_reg will see the reload-insn,
6178 or has yet to be emitted, in which case it doesn't matter
6179 because we will use this equiv reg right away. */
6180
6181 if (oldequiv == 0 && optimize
6182 && (GET_CODE (old) == MEM
6183 || (GET_CODE (old) == REG
6184 && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6185 && reg_renumber[REGNO (old)] < 0)))
6186 oldequiv = find_equiv_reg (old, insn, ALL_REGS, -1, NULL, 0, mode);
6187
6188 if (oldequiv)
6189 {
6190 unsigned int regno = true_regnum (oldequiv);
6191
6192 /* Don't use OLDEQUIV if any other reload changes it at an
6193 earlier stage of this insn or at this stage. */
6194 if (! free_for_value_p (regno, rl->mode, rl->opnum, rl->when_needed,
6195 rl->in, const0_rtx, j, 0))
6196 oldequiv = 0;
6197
6198 /* If it is no cheaper to copy from OLDEQUIV into the
6199 reload register than it would be to move from memory,
6200 don't use it. Likewise, if we need a secondary register
6201 or memory. */
6202
6203 if (oldequiv != 0
6204 && ((REGNO_REG_CLASS (regno) != rl->class
6205 && (REGISTER_MOVE_COST (mode, REGNO_REG_CLASS (regno),
6206 rl->class)
6207 >= MEMORY_MOVE_COST (mode, rl->class, 1)))
6208 #ifdef SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
6209 || (SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rl->class,
6210 mode, oldequiv)
6211 != NO_REGS)
6212 #endif
6213 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
6214 || SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (REGNO_REG_CLASS (regno),
6215 rl->class,
6216 mode)
6217 #endif
6218 ))
6219 oldequiv = 0;
6220 }
6221
6222 /* delete_output_reload is only invoked properly if old contains
6223 the original pseudo register. Since this is replaced with a
6224 hard reg when RELOAD_OVERRIDE_IN is set, see if we can
6225 find the pseudo in RELOAD_IN_REG. */
6226 if (oldequiv == 0
6227 && reload_override_in[j]
6228 && GET_CODE (rl->in_reg) == REG)
6229 {
6230 oldequiv = old;
6231 old = rl->in_reg;
6232 }
6233 if (oldequiv == 0)
6234 oldequiv = old;
6235 else if (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == REG)
6236 oldequiv_reg = oldequiv;
6237 else if (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG)
6238 oldequiv_reg = SUBREG_REG (oldequiv);
6239
6240 /* If we are reloading from a register that was recently stored in
6241 with an output-reload, see if we can prove there was
6242 actually no need to store the old value in it. */
6243
6244 if (optimize && GET_CODE (oldequiv) == REG
6245 && REGNO (oldequiv) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6246 && spill_reg_store[REGNO (oldequiv)]
6247 && GET_CODE (old) == REG
6248 && (dead_or_set_p (insn, spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)])
6249 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)],
6250 rl->out_reg)))
6251 delete_output_reload (insn, j, REGNO (oldequiv));
6252
6253 /* Encapsulate both RELOADREG and OLDEQUIV into that mode,
6254 then load RELOADREG from OLDEQUIV. Note that we cannot use
6255 gen_lowpart_common since it can do the wrong thing when
6256 RELOADREG has a multi-word mode. Note that RELOADREG
6257 must always be a REG here. */
6258
6259 if (GET_MODE (reloadreg) != mode)
6260 reloadreg = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (reloadreg));
6261 while (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG && GET_MODE (oldequiv) != mode)
6262 oldequiv = SUBREG_REG (oldequiv);
6263 if (GET_MODE (oldequiv) != VOIDmode
6264 && mode != GET_MODE (oldequiv))
6265 oldequiv = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, oldequiv);
6266
6267 /* Switch to the right place to emit the reload insns. */
6268 switch (rl->when_needed)
6269 {
6270 case RELOAD_OTHER:
6271 where = &other_input_reload_insns;
6272 break;
6273 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
6274 where = &input_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6275 break;
6276 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
6277 where = &input_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6278 break;
6279 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
6280 where = &inpaddr_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6281 break;
6282 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
6283 where = &output_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6284 break;
6285 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
6286 where = &outaddr_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6287 break;
6288 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
6289 where = &operand_reload_insns;
6290 break;
6291 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
6292 where = &other_operand_reload_insns;
6293 break;
6294 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
6295 where = &other_input_address_reload_insns;
6296 break;
6297 default:
6298 abort ();
6299 }
6300
6301 push_to_sequence (*where);
6302
6303 /* Auto-increment addresses must be reloaded in a special way. */
6304 if (rl->out && ! rl->out_reg)
6305 {
6306 /* We are not going to bother supporting the case where a
6307 incremented register can't be copied directly from
6308 OLDEQUIV since this seems highly unlikely. */
6309 if (rl->secondary_in_reload >= 0)
6310 abort ();
6311
6312 if (reload_inherited[j])
6313 oldequiv = reloadreg;
6314
6315 old = XEXP (rl->in_reg, 0);
6316
6317 if (optimize && GET_CODE (oldequiv) == REG
6318 && REGNO (oldequiv) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6319 && spill_reg_store[REGNO (oldequiv)]
6320 && GET_CODE (old) == REG
6321 && (dead_or_set_p (insn,
6322 spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)])
6323 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)],
6324 old)))
6325 delete_output_reload (insn, j, REGNO (oldequiv));
6326
6327 /* Prevent normal processing of this reload. */
6328 special = 1;
6329 /* Output a special code sequence for this case. */
6330 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (reloadreg)]
6331 = inc_for_reload (reloadreg, oldequiv, rl->out,
6332 rl->inc);
6333 }
6334
6335 /* If we are reloading a pseudo-register that was set by the previous
6336 insn, see if we can get rid of that pseudo-register entirely
6337 by redirecting the previous insn into our reload register. */
6338
6339 else if (optimize && GET_CODE (old) == REG
6340 && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6341 && dead_or_set_p (insn, old)
6342 /* This is unsafe if some other reload
6343 uses the same reg first. */
6344 && ! conflicts_with_override (reloadreg)
6345 && free_for_value_p (REGNO (reloadreg), rl->mode, rl->opnum,
6346 rl->when_needed, old, rl->out, j, 0))
6347 {
6348 rtx temp = PREV_INSN (insn);
6349 while (temp && GET_CODE (temp) == NOTE)
6350 temp = PREV_INSN (temp);
6351 if (temp
6352 && GET_CODE (temp) == INSN
6353 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (temp)) == SET
6354 && SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) == old
6355 /* Make sure we can access insn_operand_constraint. */
6356 && asm_noperands (PATTERN (temp)) < 0
6357 /* This is unsafe if prev insn rejects our reload reg. */
6358 && constraint_accepts_reg_p (insn_data[recog_memoized (temp)].operand[0].constraint,
6359 reloadreg)
6360 /* This is unsafe if operand occurs more than once in current
6361 insn. Perhaps some occurrences aren't reloaded. */
6362 && count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), old, 0) == 1
6363 /* Don't risk splitting a matching pair of operands. */
6364 && ! reg_mentioned_p (old, SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp))))
6365 {
6366 /* Store into the reload register instead of the pseudo. */
6367 SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) = reloadreg;
6368
6369 /* If the previous insn is an output reload, the source is
6370 a reload register, and its spill_reg_store entry will
6371 contain the previous destination. This is now
6372 invalid. */
6373 if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp))) == REG
6374 && REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp))) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6375 {
6376 spill_reg_store[REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp)))] = 0;
6377 spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp)))] = 0;
6378 }
6379
6380 /* If these are the only uses of the pseudo reg,
6381 pretend for GDB it lives in the reload reg we used. */
6382 if (REG_N_DEATHS (REGNO (old)) == 1
6383 && REG_N_SETS (REGNO (old)) == 1)
6384 {
6385 reg_renumber[REGNO (old)] = REGNO (rl->reg_rtx);
6386 alter_reg (REGNO (old), -1);
6387 }
6388 special = 1;
6389 }
6390 }
6391
6392 /* We can't do that, so output an insn to load RELOADREG. */
6393
6394 #ifdef SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
6395 /* If we have a secondary reload, pick up the secondary register
6396 and icode, if any. If OLDEQUIV and OLD are different or
6397 if this is an in-out reload, recompute whether or not we
6398 still need a secondary register and what the icode should
6399 be. If we still need a secondary register and the class or
6400 icode is different, go back to reloading from OLD if using
6401 OLDEQUIV means that we got the wrong type of register. We
6402 cannot have different class or icode due to an in-out reload
6403 because we don't make such reloads when both the input and
6404 output need secondary reload registers. */
6405
6406 if (! special && rl->secondary_in_reload >= 0)
6407 {
6408 rtx second_reload_reg = 0;
6409 int secondary_reload = rl->secondary_in_reload;
6410 rtx real_oldequiv = oldequiv;
6411 rtx real_old = old;
6412 rtx tmp;
6413 enum insn_code icode;
6414
6415 /* If OLDEQUIV is a pseudo with a MEM, get the real MEM
6416 and similarly for OLD.
6417 See comments in get_secondary_reload in reload.c. */
6418 /* If it is a pseudo that cannot be replaced with its
6419 equivalent MEM, we must fall back to reload_in, which
6420 will have all the necessary substitutions registered.
6421 Likewise for a pseudo that can't be replaced with its
6422 equivalent constant.
6423
6424 Take extra care for subregs of such pseudos. Note that
6425 we cannot use reg_equiv_mem in this case because it is
6426 not in the right mode. */
6427
6428 tmp = oldequiv;
6429 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG)
6430 tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp);
6431 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG
6432 && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6433 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (tmp)] != 0
6434 || reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (tmp)] != 0))
6435 {
6436 if (! reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)]
6437 || num_not_at_initial_offset
6438 || GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG)
6439 real_oldequiv = rl->in;
6440 else
6441 real_oldequiv = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)];
6442 }
6443
6444 tmp = old;
6445 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG)
6446 tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp);
6447 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG
6448 && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6449 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (tmp)] != 0
6450 || reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (tmp)] != 0))
6451 {
6452 if (! reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)]
6453 || num_not_at_initial_offset
6454 || GET_CODE (old) == SUBREG)
6455 real_old = rl->in;
6456 else
6457 real_old = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)];
6458 }
6459
6460 second_reload_reg = rld[secondary_reload].reg_rtx;
6461 icode = rl->secondary_in_icode;
6462
6463 if ((old != oldequiv && ! rtx_equal_p (old, oldequiv))
6464 || (rl->in != 0 && rl->out != 0))
6465 {
6466 enum reg_class new_class
6467 = SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rl->class,
6468 mode, real_oldequiv);
6469
6470 if (new_class == NO_REGS)
6471 second_reload_reg = 0;
6472 else
6473 {
6474 enum insn_code new_icode;
6475 enum machine_mode new_mode;
6476
6477 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) new_class],
6478 REGNO (second_reload_reg)))
6479 oldequiv = old, real_oldequiv = real_old;
6480 else
6481 {
6482 new_icode = reload_in_optab[(int) mode];
6483 if (new_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing
6484 && ((insn_data[(int) new_icode].operand[0].predicate
6485 && ! ((*insn_data[(int) new_icode].operand[0].predicate)
6486 (reloadreg, mode)))
6487 || (insn_data[(int) new_icode].operand[1].predicate
6488 && ! ((*insn_data[(int) new_icode].operand[1].predicate)
6489 (real_oldequiv, mode)))))
6490 new_icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
6491
6492 if (new_icode == CODE_FOR_nothing)
6493 new_mode = mode;
6494 else
6495 new_mode = insn_data[(int) new_icode].operand[2].mode;
6496
6497 if (GET_MODE (second_reload_reg) != new_mode)
6498 {
6499 if (!HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (second_reload_reg),
6500 new_mode))
6501 oldequiv = old, real_oldequiv = real_old;
6502 else
6503 second_reload_reg
6504 = gen_rtx_REG (new_mode,
6505 REGNO (second_reload_reg));
6506 }
6507 }
6508 }
6509 }
6510
6511 /* If we still need a secondary reload register, check
6512 to see if it is being used as a scratch or intermediate
6513 register and generate code appropriately. If we need
6514 a scratch register, use REAL_OLDEQUIV since the form of
6515 the insn may depend on the actual address if it is
6516 a MEM. */
6517
6518 if (second_reload_reg)
6519 {
6520 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6521 {
6522 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (reloadreg, real_oldequiv,
6523 second_reload_reg));
6524 special = 1;
6525 }
6526 else
6527 {
6528 /* See if we need a scratch register to load the
6529 intermediate register (a tertiary reload). */
6530 enum insn_code tertiary_icode
6531 = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_in_icode;
6532
6533 if (tertiary_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6534 {
6535 rtx third_reload_reg
6536 = rld[rld[secondary_reload].secondary_in_reload].reg_rtx;
6537
6538 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (tertiary_icode)
6539 (second_reload_reg, real_oldequiv,
6540 third_reload_reg)));
6541 }
6542 else
6543 gen_reload (second_reload_reg, real_oldequiv,
6544 rl->opnum,
6545 rl->when_needed);
6546
6547 oldequiv = second_reload_reg;
6548 }
6549 }
6550 }
6551 #endif
6552
6553 if (! special && ! rtx_equal_p (reloadreg, oldequiv))
6554 {
6555 rtx real_oldequiv = oldequiv;
6556
6557 if ((GET_CODE (oldequiv) == REG
6558 && REGNO (oldequiv) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6559 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (oldequiv)] != 0
6560 || reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (oldequiv)] != 0))
6561 || (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG
6562 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv)) == REG
6563 && (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))
6564 >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6565 && ((reg_equiv_memory_loc
6566 [REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))] != 0)
6567 || (reg_equiv_constant
6568 [REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))] != 0)))
6569 || (CONSTANT_P (oldequiv)
6570 && PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (oldequiv,
6571 REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (reloadreg))) == NO_REGS))
6572 real_oldequiv = rl->in;
6573 gen_reload (reloadreg, real_oldequiv, rl->opnum,
6574 rl->when_needed);
6575 }
6576
6577 if (flag_non_call_exceptions)
6578 copy_eh_notes (insn, get_insns ());
6579
6580 /* End this sequence. */
6581 *where = get_insns ();
6582 end_sequence ();
6583
6584 /* Update reload_override_in so that delete_address_reloads_1
6585 can see the actual register usage. */
6586 if (oldequiv_reg)
6587 reload_override_in[j] = oldequiv;
6588 }
6589
6590 /* Generate insns to for the output reload RL, which is for the insn described
6591 by CHAIN and has the number J. */
6592 static void
6593 emit_output_reload_insns (chain, rl, j)
6594 struct insn_chain *chain;
6595 struct reload *rl;
6596 int j;
6597 {
6598 rtx reloadreg = rl->reg_rtx;
6599 rtx insn = chain->insn;
6600 int special = 0;
6601 rtx old = rl->out;
6602 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (old);
6603 rtx p;
6604
6605 if (rl->when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER)
6606 start_sequence ();
6607 else
6608 push_to_sequence (output_reload_insns[rl->opnum]);
6609
6610 /* Determine the mode to reload in.
6611 See comments above (for input reloading). */
6612
6613 if (mode == VOIDmode)
6614 {
6615 /* VOIDmode should never happen for an output. */
6616 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) < 0)
6617 /* It's the compiler's fault. */
6618 fatal_insn ("VOIDmode on an output", insn);
6619 error_for_asm (insn, "output operand is constant in `asm'");
6620 /* Prevent crash--use something we know is valid. */
6621 mode = word_mode;
6622 old = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (reloadreg));
6623 }
6624
6625 if (GET_MODE (reloadreg) != mode)
6626 reloadreg = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (reloadreg));
6627
6628 #ifdef SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
6629
6630 /* If we need two reload regs, set RELOADREG to the intermediate
6631 one, since it will be stored into OLD. We might need a secondary
6632 register only for an input reload, so check again here. */
6633
6634 if (rl->secondary_out_reload >= 0)
6635 {
6636 rtx real_old = old;
6637
6638 if (GET_CODE (old) == REG && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6639 && reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (old)] != 0)
6640 real_old = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (old)];
6641
6642 if ((SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rl->class,
6643 mode, real_old)
6644 != NO_REGS))
6645 {
6646 rtx second_reloadreg = reloadreg;
6647 reloadreg = rld[rl->secondary_out_reload].reg_rtx;
6648
6649 /* See if RELOADREG is to be used as a scratch register
6650 or as an intermediate register. */
6651 if (rl->secondary_out_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6652 {
6653 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (rl->secondary_out_icode)
6654 (real_old, second_reloadreg, reloadreg)));
6655 special = 1;
6656 }
6657 else
6658 {
6659 /* See if we need both a scratch and intermediate reload
6660 register. */
6661
6662 int secondary_reload = rl->secondary_out_reload;
6663 enum insn_code tertiary_icode
6664 = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_out_icode;
6665
6666 if (GET_MODE (reloadreg) != mode)
6667 reloadreg = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (reloadreg));
6668
6669 if (tertiary_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6670 {
6671 rtx third_reloadreg
6672 = rld[rld[secondary_reload].secondary_out_reload].reg_rtx;
6673 rtx tem;
6674
6675 /* Copy primary reload reg to secondary reload reg.
6676 (Note that these have been swapped above, then
6677 secondary reload reg to OLD using our insn.) */
6678
6679 /* If REAL_OLD is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it
6680 and try to put the opposite SUBREG on
6681 RELOADREG. */
6682 if (GET_CODE (real_old) == SUBREG
6683 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (real_old))
6684 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (real_old))))
6685 && 0 != (tem = gen_lowpart_common
6686 (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (real_old)),
6687 reloadreg)))
6688 real_old = SUBREG_REG (real_old), reloadreg = tem;
6689
6690 gen_reload (reloadreg, second_reloadreg,
6691 rl->opnum, rl->when_needed);
6692 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (tertiary_icode)
6693 (real_old, reloadreg, third_reloadreg)));
6694 special = 1;
6695 }
6696
6697 else
6698 /* Copy between the reload regs here and then to
6699 OUT later. */
6700
6701 gen_reload (reloadreg, second_reloadreg,
6702 rl->opnum, rl->when_needed);
6703 }
6704 }
6705 }
6706 #endif
6707
6708 /* Output the last reload insn. */
6709 if (! special)
6710 {
6711 rtx set;
6712
6713 /* Don't output the last reload if OLD is not the dest of
6714 INSN and is in the src and is clobbered by INSN. */
6715 if (! flag_expensive_optimizations
6716 || GET_CODE (old) != REG
6717 || !(set = single_set (insn))
6718 || rtx_equal_p (old, SET_DEST (set))
6719 || !reg_mentioned_p (old, SET_SRC (set))
6720 || !regno_clobbered_p (REGNO (old), insn, rl->mode, 0))
6721 gen_reload (old, reloadreg, rl->opnum,
6722 rl->when_needed);
6723 }
6724
6725 /* Look at all insns we emitted, just to be safe. */
6726 for (p = get_insns (); p; p = NEXT_INSN (p))
6727 if (INSN_P (p))
6728 {
6729 rtx pat = PATTERN (p);
6730
6731 /* If this output reload doesn't come from a spill reg,
6732 clear any memory of reloaded copies of the pseudo reg.
6733 If this output reload comes from a spill reg,
6734 reg_has_output_reload will make this do nothing. */
6735 note_stores (pat, forget_old_reloads_1, NULL);
6736
6737 if (reg_mentioned_p (rl->reg_rtx, pat))
6738 {
6739 rtx set = single_set (insn);
6740 if (reload_spill_index[j] < 0
6741 && set
6742 && SET_SRC (set) == rl->reg_rtx)
6743 {
6744 int src = REGNO (SET_SRC (set));
6745
6746 reload_spill_index[j] = src;
6747 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, src);
6748 if (find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, src))
6749 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src);
6750 }
6751 if (REGNO (rl->reg_rtx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6752 {
6753 int s = rl->secondary_out_reload;
6754 set = single_set (p);
6755 /* If this reload copies only to the secondary reload
6756 register, the secondary reload does the actual
6757 store. */
6758 if (s >= 0 && set == NULL_RTX)
6759 /* We can't tell what function the secondary reload
6760 has and where the actual store to the pseudo is
6761 made; leave new_spill_reg_store alone. */
6762 ;
6763 else if (s >= 0
6764 && SET_SRC (set) == rl->reg_rtx
6765 && SET_DEST (set) == rld[s].reg_rtx)
6766 {
6767 /* Usually the next instruction will be the
6768 secondary reload insn; if we can confirm
6769 that it is, setting new_spill_reg_store to
6770 that insn will allow an extra optimization. */
6771 rtx s_reg = rld[s].reg_rtx;
6772 rtx next = NEXT_INSN (p);
6773 rld[s].out = rl->out;
6774 rld[s].out_reg = rl->out_reg;
6775 set = single_set (next);
6776 if (set && SET_SRC (set) == s_reg
6777 && ! new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (s_reg)])
6778 {
6779 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
6780 REGNO (s_reg));
6781 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (s_reg)] = next;
6782 }
6783 }
6784 else
6785 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (rl->reg_rtx)] = p;
6786 }
6787 }
6788 }
6789
6790 if (rl->when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER)
6791 {
6792 emit_insns (other_output_reload_insns[rl->opnum]);
6793 other_output_reload_insns[rl->opnum] = get_insns ();
6794 }
6795 else
6796 output_reload_insns[rl->opnum] = get_insns ();
6797
6798 if (flag_non_call_exceptions)
6799 copy_eh_notes (insn, get_insns ());
6800
6801 end_sequence ();
6802 }
6803
6804 /* Do input reloading for reload RL, which is for the insn described by CHAIN
6805 and has the number J. */
6806 static void
6807 do_input_reload (chain, rl, j)
6808 struct insn_chain *chain;
6809 struct reload *rl;
6810 int j;
6811 {
6812 int expect_occurrences = 1;
6813 rtx insn = chain->insn;
6814 rtx old = (rl->in && GET_CODE (rl->in) == MEM
6815 ? rl->in_reg : rl->in);
6816
6817 if (old != 0
6818 /* AUTO_INC reloads need to be handled even if inherited. We got an
6819 AUTO_INC reload if reload_out is set but reload_out_reg isn't. */
6820 && (! reload_inherited[j] || (rl->out && ! rl->out_reg))
6821 && ! rtx_equal_p (rl->reg_rtx, old)
6822 && rl->reg_rtx != 0)
6823 emit_input_reload_insns (chain, rld + j, old, j);
6824
6825 /* When inheriting a wider reload, we have a MEM in rl->in,
6826 e.g. inheriting a SImode output reload for
6827 (mem:HI (plus:SI (reg:SI 14 fp) (const_int 10))) */
6828 if (optimize && reload_inherited[j] && rl->in
6829 && GET_CODE (rl->in) == MEM
6830 && GET_CODE (rl->in_reg) == MEM
6831 && reload_spill_index[j] >= 0
6832 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, reload_spill_index[j]))
6833 {
6834 expect_occurrences
6835 = count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), rl->in, 0) == 1 ? 0 : -1;
6836 rl->in = regno_reg_rtx[reg_reloaded_contents[reload_spill_index[j]]];
6837 }
6838
6839 /* If we are reloading a register that was recently stored in with an
6840 output-reload, see if we can prove there was
6841 actually no need to store the old value in it. */
6842
6843 if (optimize
6844 && (reload_inherited[j] || reload_override_in[j])
6845 && rl->reg_rtx
6846 && GET_CODE (rl->reg_rtx) == REG
6847 && spill_reg_store[REGNO (rl->reg_rtx)] != 0
6848 #if 0
6849 /* There doesn't seem to be any reason to restrict this to pseudos
6850 and doing so loses in the case where we are copying from a
6851 register of the wrong class. */
6852 && (REGNO (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (rl->reg_rtx)])
6853 >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6854 #endif
6855 /* The insn might have already some references to stackslots
6856 replaced by MEMs, while reload_out_reg still names the
6857 original pseudo. */
6858 && (dead_or_set_p (insn,
6859 spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (rl->reg_rtx)])
6860 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (rl->reg_rtx)],
6861 rl->out_reg)))
6862 delete_output_reload (insn, j, REGNO (rl->reg_rtx));
6863 }
6864
6865 /* Do output reloading for reload RL, which is for the insn described by
6866 CHAIN and has the number J.
6867 ??? At some point we need to support handling output reloads of
6868 JUMP_INSNs or insns that set cc0. */
6869 static void
6870 do_output_reload (chain, rl, j)
6871 struct insn_chain *chain;
6872 struct reload *rl;
6873 int j;
6874 {
6875 rtx note, old;
6876 rtx insn = chain->insn;
6877 /* If this is an output reload that stores something that is
6878 not loaded in this same reload, see if we can eliminate a previous
6879 store. */
6880 rtx pseudo = rl->out_reg;
6881
6882 if (pseudo
6883 && GET_CODE (pseudo) == REG
6884 && ! rtx_equal_p (rl->in_reg, pseudo)
6885 && REGNO (pseudo) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6886 && reg_last_reload_reg[REGNO (pseudo)])
6887 {
6888 int pseudo_no = REGNO (pseudo);
6889 int last_regno = REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[pseudo_no]);
6890
6891 /* We don't need to test full validity of last_regno for
6892 inherit here; we only want to know if the store actually
6893 matches the pseudo. */
6894 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, last_regno)
6895 && reg_reloaded_contents[last_regno] == pseudo_no
6896 && spill_reg_store[last_regno]
6897 && rtx_equal_p (pseudo, spill_reg_stored_to[last_regno]))
6898 delete_output_reload (insn, j, last_regno);
6899 }
6900
6901 old = rl->out_reg;
6902 if (old == 0
6903 || rl->reg_rtx == old
6904 || rl->reg_rtx == 0)
6905 return;
6906
6907 /* An output operand that dies right away does need a reload,
6908 but need not be copied from it. Show the new location in the
6909 REG_UNUSED note. */
6910 if ((GET_CODE (old) == REG || GET_CODE (old) == SCRATCH)
6911 && (note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_UNUSED, old)) != 0)
6912 {
6913 XEXP (note, 0) = rl->reg_rtx;
6914 return;
6915 }
6916 /* Likewise for a SUBREG of an operand that dies. */
6917 else if (GET_CODE (old) == SUBREG
6918 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (old)) == REG
6919 && 0 != (note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_UNUSED,
6920 SUBREG_REG (old))))
6921 {
6922 XEXP (note, 0) = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (old),
6923 rl->reg_rtx);
6924 return;
6925 }
6926 else if (GET_CODE (old) == SCRATCH)
6927 /* If we aren't optimizing, there won't be a REG_UNUSED note,
6928 but we don't want to make an output reload. */
6929 return;
6930
6931 /* If is a JUMP_INSN, we can't support output reloads yet. */
6932 if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN)
6933 abort ();
6934
6935 emit_output_reload_insns (chain, rld + j, j);
6936 }
6937
6938 /* Output insns to reload values in and out of the chosen reload regs. */
6939
6940 static void
6941 emit_reload_insns (chain)
6942 struct insn_chain *chain;
6943 {
6944 rtx insn = chain->insn;
6945
6946 register int j;
6947 rtx following_insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
6948 rtx before_insn = PREV_INSN (insn);
6949
6950 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_died);
6951
6952 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
6953 input_reload_insns[j] = input_address_reload_insns[j]
6954 = inpaddr_address_reload_insns[j]
6955 = output_reload_insns[j] = output_address_reload_insns[j]
6956 = outaddr_address_reload_insns[j]
6957 = other_output_reload_insns[j] = 0;
6958 other_input_address_reload_insns = 0;
6959 other_input_reload_insns = 0;
6960 operand_reload_insns = 0;
6961 other_operand_reload_insns = 0;
6962
6963 /* Dump reloads into the dump file. */
6964 if (rtl_dump_file)
6965 {
6966 fprintf (rtl_dump_file, "\nReloads for insn # %d\n", INSN_UID (insn));
6967 debug_reload_to_stream (rtl_dump_file);
6968 }
6969
6970 /* Now output the instructions to copy the data into and out of the
6971 reload registers. Do these in the order that the reloads were reported,
6972 since reloads of base and index registers precede reloads of operands
6973 and the operands may need the base and index registers reloaded. */
6974
6975 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6976 {
6977 if (rld[j].reg_rtx
6978 && REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6979 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx)] = 0;
6980
6981 do_input_reload (chain, rld + j, j);
6982 do_output_reload (chain, rld + j, j);
6983 }
6984
6985 /* Now write all the insns we made for reloads in the order expected by
6986 the allocation functions. Prior to the insn being reloaded, we write
6987 the following reloads:
6988
6989 RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reloads for input addresses.
6990
6991 RELOAD_OTHER reloads.
6992
6993 For each operand, any RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reloads followed
6994 by any RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS reloads followed by the
6995 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reload for the operand.
6996
6997 RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDRS reloads.
6998
6999 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads.
7000
7001 After the insn being reloaded, we write the following:
7002
7003 For each operand, any RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reloads followed
7004 by any RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload followed by the
7005 RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reload, followed by any RELOAD_OTHER output
7006 reloads for the operand. The RELOAD_OTHER output reloads are
7007 output in descending order by reload number. */
7008
7009 emit_insns_before (other_input_address_reload_insns, insn);
7010 emit_insns_before (other_input_reload_insns, insn);
7011
7012 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
7013 {
7014 emit_insns_before (inpaddr_address_reload_insns[j], insn);
7015 emit_insns_before (input_address_reload_insns[j], insn);
7016 emit_insns_before (input_reload_insns[j], insn);
7017 }
7018
7019 emit_insns_before (other_operand_reload_insns, insn);
7020 emit_insns_before (operand_reload_insns, insn);
7021
7022 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
7023 {
7024 emit_insns_before (outaddr_address_reload_insns[j], following_insn);
7025 emit_insns_before (output_address_reload_insns[j], following_insn);
7026 emit_insns_before (output_reload_insns[j], following_insn);
7027 emit_insns_before (other_output_reload_insns[j], following_insn);
7028 }
7029
7030 /* Keep basic block info up to date. */
7031 if (n_basic_blocks)
7032 {
7033 if (BLOCK_HEAD (chain->block) == insn)
7034 BLOCK_HEAD (chain->block) = NEXT_INSN (before_insn);
7035 if (BLOCK_END (chain->block) == insn)
7036 BLOCK_END (chain->block) = PREV_INSN (following_insn);
7037 }
7038
7039 /* For all the spill regs newly reloaded in this instruction,
7040 record what they were reloaded from, so subsequent instructions
7041 can inherit the reloads.
7042
7043 Update spill_reg_store for the reloads of this insn.
7044 Copy the elements that were updated in the loop above. */
7045
7046 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
7047 {
7048 register int r = reload_order[j];
7049 register int i = reload_spill_index[r];
7050
7051 /* If this is a non-inherited input reload from a pseudo, we must
7052 clear any memory of a previous store to the same pseudo. Only do
7053 something if there will not be an output reload for the pseudo
7054 being reloaded. */
7055 if (rld[r].in_reg != 0
7056 && ! (reload_inherited[r] || reload_override_in[r]))
7057 {
7058 rtx reg = rld[r].in_reg;
7059
7060 if (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG)
7061 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
7062
7063 if (GET_CODE (reg) == REG
7064 && REGNO (reg) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7065 && ! reg_has_output_reload[REGNO (reg)])
7066 {
7067 int nregno = REGNO (reg);
7068
7069 if (reg_last_reload_reg[nregno])
7070 {
7071 int last_regno = REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[nregno]);
7072
7073 if (reg_reloaded_contents[last_regno] == nregno)
7074 spill_reg_store[last_regno] = 0;
7075 }
7076 }
7077 }
7078
7079 /* I is nonneg if this reload used a register.
7080 If rld[r].reg_rtx is 0, this is an optional reload
7081 that we opted to ignore. */
7082
7083 if (i >= 0 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0)
7084 {
7085 int nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i, GET_MODE (rld[r].reg_rtx));
7086 int k;
7087 int part_reaches_end = 0;
7088 int all_reaches_end = 1;
7089
7090 /* For a multi register reload, we need to check if all or part
7091 of the value lives to the end. */
7092 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
7093 {
7094 if (reload_reg_reaches_end_p (i + k, rld[r].opnum,
7095 rld[r].when_needed))
7096 part_reaches_end = 1;
7097 else
7098 all_reaches_end = 0;
7099 }
7100
7101 /* Ignore reloads that don't reach the end of the insn in
7102 entirety. */
7103 if (all_reaches_end)
7104 {
7105 /* First, clear out memory of what used to be in this spill reg.
7106 If consecutive registers are used, clear them all. */
7107
7108 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
7109 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
7110
7111 /* Maybe the spill reg contains a copy of reload_out. */
7112 if (rld[r].out != 0
7113 && (GET_CODE (rld[r].out) == REG
7114 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
7115 || ! rld[r].out_reg
7116 #endif
7117 || GET_CODE (rld[r].out_reg) == REG))
7118 {
7119 rtx out = (GET_CODE (rld[r].out) == REG
7120 ? rld[r].out
7121 : rld[r].out_reg
7122 ? rld[r].out_reg
7123 /* AUTO_INC */ : XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
7124 register int nregno = REGNO (out);
7125 int nnr = (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER ? 1
7126 : HARD_REGNO_NREGS (nregno,
7127 GET_MODE (rld[r].reg_rtx)));
7128
7129 spill_reg_store[i] = new_spill_reg_store[i];
7130 spill_reg_stored_to[i] = out;
7131 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno] = rld[r].reg_rtx;
7132
7133 /* If NREGNO is a hard register, it may occupy more than
7134 one register. If it does, say what is in the
7135 rest of the registers assuming that both registers
7136 agree on how many words the object takes. If not,
7137 invalidate the subsequent registers. */
7138
7139 if (nregno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7140 for (k = 1; k < nnr; k++)
7141 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno + k]
7142 = (nr == nnr
7143 ? gen_rtx_REG (reg_raw_mode[REGNO (rld[r].reg_rtx) + k],
7144 REGNO (rld[r].reg_rtx) + k)
7145 : 0);
7146
7147 /* Now do the inverse operation. */
7148 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
7149 {
7150 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, i + k);
7151 reg_reloaded_contents[i + k]
7152 = (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER || nr != nnr
7153 ? nregno
7154 : nregno + k);
7155 reg_reloaded_insn[i + k] = insn;
7156 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
7157 }
7158 }
7159
7160 /* Maybe the spill reg contains a copy of reload_in. Only do
7161 something if there will not be an output reload for
7162 the register being reloaded. */
7163 else if (rld[r].out_reg == 0
7164 && rld[r].in != 0
7165 && ((GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == REG
7166 && REGNO (rld[r].in) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7167 && ! reg_has_output_reload[REGNO (rld[r].in)])
7168 || (GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == REG
7169 && ! reg_has_output_reload[REGNO (rld[r].in_reg)]))
7170 && ! reg_set_p (rld[r].reg_rtx, PATTERN (insn)))
7171 {
7172 register int nregno;
7173 int nnr;
7174
7175 if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == REG
7176 && REGNO (rld[r].in) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7177 nregno = REGNO (rld[r].in);
7178 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == REG)
7179 nregno = REGNO (rld[r].in_reg);
7180 else
7181 nregno = REGNO (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
7182
7183 nnr = (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER ? 1
7184 : HARD_REGNO_NREGS (nregno,
7185 GET_MODE (rld[r].reg_rtx)));
7186
7187 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno] = rld[r].reg_rtx;
7188
7189 if (nregno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7190 for (k = 1; k < nnr; k++)
7191 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno + k]
7192 = (nr == nnr
7193 ? gen_rtx_REG (reg_raw_mode[REGNO (rld[r].reg_rtx) + k],
7194 REGNO (rld[r].reg_rtx) + k)
7195 : 0);
7196
7197 /* Unless we inherited this reload, show we haven't
7198 recently done a store.
7199 Previous stores of inherited auto_inc expressions
7200 also have to be discarded. */
7201 if (! reload_inherited[r]
7202 || (rld[r].out && ! rld[r].out_reg))
7203 spill_reg_store[i] = 0;
7204
7205 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
7206 {
7207 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, i + k);
7208 reg_reloaded_contents[i + k]
7209 = (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER || nr != nnr
7210 ? nregno
7211 : nregno + k);
7212 reg_reloaded_insn[i + k] = insn;
7213 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
7214 }
7215 }
7216 }
7217
7218 /* However, if part of the reload reaches the end, then we must
7219 invalidate the old info for the part that survives to the end. */
7220 else if (part_reaches_end)
7221 {
7222 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
7223 if (reload_reg_reaches_end_p (i + k,
7224 rld[r].opnum,
7225 rld[r].when_needed))
7226 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
7227 }
7228 }
7229
7230 /* The following if-statement was #if 0'd in 1.34 (or before...).
7231 It's reenabled in 1.35 because supposedly nothing else
7232 deals with this problem. */
7233
7234 /* If a register gets output-reloaded from a non-spill register,
7235 that invalidates any previous reloaded copy of it.
7236 But forget_old_reloads_1 won't get to see it, because
7237 it thinks only about the original insn. So invalidate it here. */
7238 if (i < 0 && rld[r].out != 0
7239 && (GET_CODE (rld[r].out) == REG
7240 || (GET_CODE (rld[r].out) == MEM
7241 && GET_CODE (rld[r].out_reg) == REG)))
7242 {
7243 rtx out = (GET_CODE (rld[r].out) == REG
7244 ? rld[r].out : rld[r].out_reg);
7245 register int nregno = REGNO (out);
7246 if (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7247 {
7248 rtx src_reg, store_insn = NULL_RTX;
7249
7250 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno] = 0;
7251
7252 /* If we can find a hard register that is stored, record
7253 the storing insn so that we may delete this insn with
7254 delete_output_reload. */
7255 src_reg = rld[r].reg_rtx;
7256
7257 /* If this is an optional reload, try to find the source reg
7258 from an input reload. */
7259 if (! src_reg)
7260 {
7261 rtx set = single_set (insn);
7262 if (set && SET_DEST (set) == rld[r].out)
7263 {
7264 int k;
7265
7266 src_reg = SET_SRC (set);
7267 store_insn = insn;
7268 for (k = 0; k < n_reloads; k++)
7269 {
7270 if (rld[k].in == src_reg)
7271 {
7272 src_reg = rld[k].reg_rtx;
7273 break;
7274 }
7275 }
7276 }
7277 }
7278 else
7279 store_insn = new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (src_reg)];
7280 if (src_reg && GET_CODE (src_reg) == REG
7281 && REGNO (src_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7282 {
7283 int src_regno = REGNO (src_reg);
7284 int nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (src_regno, rld[r].mode);
7285 /* The place where to find a death note varies with
7286 PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P . The condition is not
7287 necessarily checked exactly in the code that moves
7288 notes, so just check both locations. */
7289 rtx note = find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, src_regno);
7290 if (! note)
7291 note = find_regno_note (store_insn, REG_DEAD, src_regno);
7292 while (nr-- > 0)
7293 {
7294 spill_reg_store[src_regno + nr] = store_insn;
7295 spill_reg_stored_to[src_regno + nr] = out;
7296 reg_reloaded_contents[src_regno + nr] = nregno;
7297 reg_reloaded_insn[src_regno + nr] = store_insn;
7298 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, src_regno + nr);
7299 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, src_regno + nr);
7300 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, src_regno + nr);
7301 if (note)
7302 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src_regno);
7303 else
7304 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src_regno);
7305 }
7306 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno] = src_reg;
7307 }
7308 }
7309 else
7310 {
7311 int num_regs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (nregno, GET_MODE (rld[r].out));
7312
7313 while (num_regs-- > 0)
7314 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno + num_regs] = 0;
7315 }
7316 }
7317 }
7318 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_dead, reg_reloaded_died);
7319 }
7320 \f
7321 /* Emit code to perform a reload from IN (which may be a reload register) to
7322 OUT (which may also be a reload register). IN or OUT is from operand
7323 OPNUM with reload type TYPE.
7324
7325 Returns first insn emitted. */
7326
7327 rtx
7328 gen_reload (out, in, opnum, type)
7329 rtx out;
7330 rtx in;
7331 int opnum;
7332 enum reload_type type;
7333 {
7334 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
7335 rtx tem;
7336
7337 /* If IN is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it and try to put the
7338 opposite SUBREG on OUT. Likewise for a paradoxical SUBREG on OUT. */
7339 if (GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG
7340 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (in))
7341 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in))))
7342 && (tem = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in)), out)) != 0)
7343 in = SUBREG_REG (in), out = tem;
7344 else if (GET_CODE (out) == SUBREG
7345 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (out))
7346 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (out))))
7347 && (tem = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (out)), in)) != 0)
7348 out = SUBREG_REG (out), in = tem;
7349
7350 /* How to do this reload can get quite tricky. Normally, we are being
7351 asked to reload a simple operand, such as a MEM, a constant, or a pseudo
7352 register that didn't get a hard register. In that case we can just
7353 call emit_move_insn.
7354
7355 We can also be asked to reload a PLUS that adds a register or a MEM to
7356 another register, constant or MEM. This can occur during frame pointer
7357 elimination and while reloading addresses. This case is handled by
7358 trying to emit a single insn to perform the add. If it is not valid,
7359 we use a two insn sequence.
7360
7361 Finally, we could be called to handle an 'o' constraint by putting
7362 an address into a register. In that case, we first try to do this
7363 with a named pattern of "reload_load_address". If no such pattern
7364 exists, we just emit a SET insn and hope for the best (it will normally
7365 be valid on machines that use 'o').
7366
7367 This entire process is made complex because reload will never
7368 process the insns we generate here and so we must ensure that
7369 they will fit their constraints and also by the fact that parts of
7370 IN might be being reloaded separately and replaced with spill registers.
7371 Because of this, we are, in some sense, just guessing the right approach
7372 here. The one listed above seems to work.
7373
7374 ??? At some point, this whole thing needs to be rethought. */
7375
7376 if (GET_CODE (in) == PLUS
7377 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 0)) == REG
7378 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 0)) == SUBREG
7379 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 0)) == MEM)
7380 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == REG
7381 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == SUBREG
7382 || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (in, 1))
7383 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == MEM))
7384 {
7385 /* We need to compute the sum of a register or a MEM and another
7386 register, constant, or MEM, and put it into the reload
7387 register. The best possible way of doing this is if the machine
7388 has a three-operand ADD insn that accepts the required operands.
7389
7390 The simplest approach is to try to generate such an insn and see if it
7391 is recognized and matches its constraints. If so, it can be used.
7392
7393 It might be better not to actually emit the insn unless it is valid,
7394 but we need to pass the insn as an operand to `recog' and
7395 `extract_insn' and it is simpler to emit and then delete the insn if
7396 not valid than to dummy things up. */
7397
7398 rtx op0, op1, tem, insn;
7399 int code;
7400
7401 op0 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 0));
7402 op1 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 1));
7403
7404 /* Since constraint checking is strict, commutativity won't be
7405 checked, so we need to do that here to avoid spurious failure
7406 if the add instruction is two-address and the second operand
7407 of the add is the same as the reload reg, which is frequently
7408 the case. If the insn would be A = B + A, rearrange it so
7409 it will be A = A + B as constrain_operands expects. */
7410
7411 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == REG
7412 && REGNO (out) == REGNO (XEXP (in, 1)))
7413 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
7414
7415 if (op0 != XEXP (in, 0) || op1 != XEXP (in, 1))
7416 in = gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (in), op0, op1);
7417
7418 insn = emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
7419 code = recog_memoized (insn);
7420
7421 if (code >= 0)
7422 {
7423 extract_insn (insn);
7424 /* We want constrain operands to treat this insn strictly in
7425 its validity determination, i.e., the way it would after reload
7426 has completed. */
7427 if (constrain_operands (1))
7428 return insn;
7429 }
7430
7431 delete_insns_since (last);
7432
7433 /* If that failed, we must use a conservative two-insn sequence.
7434
7435 Use a move to copy one operand into the reload register. Prefer
7436 to reload a constant, MEM or pseudo since the move patterns can
7437 handle an arbitrary operand. If OP1 is not a constant, MEM or
7438 pseudo and OP1 is not a valid operand for an add instruction, then
7439 reload OP1.
7440
7441 After reloading one of the operands into the reload register, add
7442 the reload register to the output register.
7443
7444 If there is another way to do this for a specific machine, a
7445 DEFINE_PEEPHOLE should be specified that recognizes the sequence
7446 we emit below. */
7447
7448 code = (int) add_optab->handlers[(int) GET_MODE (out)].insn_code;
7449
7450 if (CONSTANT_P (op1) || GET_CODE (op1) == MEM || GET_CODE (op1) == SUBREG
7451 || (GET_CODE (op1) == REG
7452 && REGNO (op1) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7453 || (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
7454 && ! ((*insn_data[code].operand[2].predicate)
7455 (op1, insn_data[code].operand[2].mode))))
7456 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
7457
7458 gen_reload (out, op0, opnum, type);
7459
7460 /* If OP0 and OP1 are the same, we can use OUT for OP1.
7461 This fixes a problem on the 32K where the stack pointer cannot
7462 be used as an operand of an add insn. */
7463
7464 if (rtx_equal_p (op0, op1))
7465 op1 = out;
7466
7467 insn = emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (out, op1));
7468
7469 /* If that failed, copy the address register to the reload register.
7470 Then add the constant to the reload register. */
7471
7472 code = recog_memoized (insn);
7473
7474 if (code >= 0)
7475 {
7476 extract_insn (insn);
7477 /* We want constrain operands to treat this insn strictly in
7478 its validity determination, i.e., the way it would after reload
7479 has completed. */
7480 if (constrain_operands (1))
7481 {
7482 /* Add a REG_EQUIV note so that find_equiv_reg can find it. */
7483 REG_NOTES (insn)
7484 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV, in, REG_NOTES (insn));
7485 return insn;
7486 }
7487 }
7488
7489 delete_insns_since (last);
7490
7491 gen_reload (out, op1, opnum, type);
7492 insn = emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (out, op0));
7493 REG_NOTES (insn) = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV, in, REG_NOTES (insn));
7494 }
7495
7496 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
7497 /* If we need a memory location to do the move, do it that way. */
7498 else if (GET_CODE (in) == REG && REGNO (in) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7499 && GET_CODE (out) == REG && REGNO (out) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7500 && SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (in)),
7501 REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (out)),
7502 GET_MODE (out)))
7503 {
7504 /* Get the memory to use and rewrite both registers to its mode. */
7505 rtx loc = get_secondary_mem (in, GET_MODE (out), opnum, type);
7506
7507 if (GET_MODE (loc) != GET_MODE (out))
7508 out = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (loc), REGNO (out));
7509
7510 if (GET_MODE (loc) != GET_MODE (in))
7511 in = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (loc), REGNO (in));
7512
7513 gen_reload (loc, in, opnum, type);
7514 gen_reload (out, loc, opnum, type);
7515 }
7516 #endif
7517
7518 /* If IN is a simple operand, use gen_move_insn. */
7519 else if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (in)) == 'o' || GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG)
7520 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (out, in));
7521
7522 #ifdef HAVE_reload_load_address
7523 else if (HAVE_reload_load_address)
7524 emit_insn (gen_reload_load_address (out, in));
7525 #endif
7526
7527 /* Otherwise, just write (set OUT IN) and hope for the best. */
7528 else
7529 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
7530
7531 /* Return the first insn emitted.
7532 We can not just return get_last_insn, because there may have
7533 been multiple instructions emitted. Also note that gen_move_insn may
7534 emit more than one insn itself, so we can not assume that there is one
7535 insn emitted per emit_insn_before call. */
7536
7537 return last ? NEXT_INSN (last) : get_insns ();
7538 }
7539 \f
7540 /* Delete a previously made output-reload
7541 whose result we now believe is not needed.
7542 First we double-check.
7543
7544 INSN is the insn now being processed.
7545 LAST_RELOAD_REG is the hard register number for which we want to delete
7546 the last output reload.
7547 J is the reload-number that originally used REG. The caller has made
7548 certain that reload J doesn't use REG any longer for input. */
7549
7550 static void
7551 delete_output_reload (insn, j, last_reload_reg)
7552 rtx insn;
7553 int j;
7554 int last_reload_reg;
7555 {
7556 rtx output_reload_insn = spill_reg_store[last_reload_reg];
7557 rtx reg = spill_reg_stored_to[last_reload_reg];
7558 int k;
7559 int n_occurrences;
7560 int n_inherited = 0;
7561 register rtx i1;
7562 rtx substed;
7563
7564 /* Get the raw pseudo-register referred to. */
7565
7566 while (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG)
7567 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
7568 substed = reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (reg)];
7569
7570 /* This is unsafe if the operand occurs more often in the current
7571 insn than it is inherited. */
7572 for (k = n_reloads - 1; k >= 0; k--)
7573 {
7574 rtx reg2 = rld[k].in;
7575 if (! reg2)
7576 continue;
7577 if (GET_CODE (reg2) == MEM || reload_override_in[k])
7578 reg2 = rld[k].in_reg;
7579 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
7580 if (rld[k].out && ! rld[k].out_reg)
7581 reg2 = XEXP (rld[k].in_reg, 0);
7582 #endif
7583 while (GET_CODE (reg2) == SUBREG)
7584 reg2 = SUBREG_REG (reg2);
7585 if (rtx_equal_p (reg2, reg))
7586 {
7587 if (reload_inherited[k] || reload_override_in[k] || k == j)
7588 {
7589 n_inherited++;
7590 reg2 = rld[k].out_reg;
7591 if (! reg2)
7592 continue;
7593 while (GET_CODE (reg2) == SUBREG)
7594 reg2 = XEXP (reg2, 0);
7595 if (rtx_equal_p (reg2, reg))
7596 n_inherited++;
7597 }
7598 else
7599 return;
7600 }
7601 }
7602 n_occurrences = count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), reg, 0);
7603 if (substed)
7604 n_occurrences += count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn),
7605 eliminate_regs (substed, 0,
7606 NULL_RTX), 0);
7607 if (n_occurrences > n_inherited)
7608 return;
7609
7610 /* If the pseudo-reg we are reloading is no longer referenced
7611 anywhere between the store into it and here,
7612 and no jumps or labels intervene, then the value can get
7613 here through the reload reg alone.
7614 Otherwise, give up--return. */
7615 for (i1 = NEXT_INSN (output_reload_insn);
7616 i1 != insn; i1 = NEXT_INSN (i1))
7617 {
7618 if (GET_CODE (i1) == CODE_LABEL || GET_CODE (i1) == JUMP_INSN)
7619 return;
7620 if ((GET_CODE (i1) == INSN || GET_CODE (i1) == CALL_INSN)
7621 && reg_mentioned_p (reg, PATTERN (i1)))
7622 {
7623 /* If this is USE in front of INSN, we only have to check that
7624 there are no more references than accounted for by inheritance. */
7625 while (GET_CODE (i1) == INSN && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i1)) == USE)
7626 {
7627 n_occurrences += rtx_equal_p (reg, XEXP (PATTERN (i1), 0)) != 0;
7628 i1 = NEXT_INSN (i1);
7629 }
7630 if (n_occurrences <= n_inherited && i1 == insn)
7631 break;
7632 return;
7633 }
7634 }
7635
7636 /* The caller has already checked that REG dies or is set in INSN.
7637 It has also checked that we are optimizing, and thus some inaccurancies
7638 in the debugging information are acceptable.
7639 So we could just delete output_reload_insn.
7640 But in some cases we can improve the debugging information without
7641 sacrificing optimization - maybe even improving the code:
7642 See if the pseudo reg has been completely replaced
7643 with reload regs. If so, delete the store insn
7644 and forget we had a stack slot for the pseudo. */
7645 if (rld[j].out != rld[j].in
7646 && REG_N_DEATHS (REGNO (reg)) == 1
7647 && REG_N_SETS (REGNO (reg)) == 1
7648 && REG_BASIC_BLOCK (REGNO (reg)) >= 0
7649 && find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, REGNO (reg)))
7650 {
7651 rtx i2;
7652
7653 /* We know that it was used only between here
7654 and the beginning of the current basic block.
7655 (We also know that the last use before INSN was
7656 the output reload we are thinking of deleting, but never mind that.)
7657 Search that range; see if any ref remains. */
7658 for (i2 = PREV_INSN (insn); i2; i2 = PREV_INSN (i2))
7659 {
7660 rtx set = single_set (i2);
7661
7662 /* Uses which just store in the pseudo don't count,
7663 since if they are the only uses, they are dead. */
7664 if (set != 0 && SET_DEST (set) == reg)
7665 continue;
7666 if (GET_CODE (i2) == CODE_LABEL
7667 || GET_CODE (i2) == JUMP_INSN)
7668 break;
7669 if ((GET_CODE (i2) == INSN || GET_CODE (i2) == CALL_INSN)
7670 && reg_mentioned_p (reg, PATTERN (i2)))
7671 {
7672 /* Some other ref remains; just delete the output reload we
7673 know to be dead. */
7674 delete_address_reloads (output_reload_insn, insn);
7675 PUT_CODE (output_reload_insn, NOTE);
7676 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (output_reload_insn) = 0;
7677 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (output_reload_insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
7678 return;
7679 }
7680 }
7681
7682 /* Delete the now-dead stores into this pseudo. */
7683 for (i2 = PREV_INSN (insn); i2; i2 = PREV_INSN (i2))
7684 {
7685 rtx set = single_set (i2);
7686
7687 if (set != 0 && SET_DEST (set) == reg)
7688 {
7689 delete_address_reloads (i2, insn);
7690 /* This might be a basic block head,
7691 thus don't use delete_insn. */
7692 PUT_CODE (i2, NOTE);
7693 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (i2) = 0;
7694 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (i2) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
7695 }
7696 if (GET_CODE (i2) == CODE_LABEL
7697 || GET_CODE (i2) == JUMP_INSN)
7698 break;
7699 }
7700
7701 /* For the debugging info,
7702 say the pseudo lives in this reload reg. */
7703 reg_renumber[REGNO (reg)] = REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx);
7704 alter_reg (REGNO (reg), -1);
7705 }
7706 delete_address_reloads (output_reload_insn, insn);
7707 PUT_CODE (output_reload_insn, NOTE);
7708 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (output_reload_insn) = 0;
7709 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (output_reload_insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
7710
7711 }
7712
7713 /* We are going to delete DEAD_INSN. Recursively delete loads of
7714 reload registers used in DEAD_INSN that are not used till CURRENT_INSN.
7715 CURRENT_INSN is being reloaded, so we have to check its reloads too. */
7716 static void
7717 delete_address_reloads (dead_insn, current_insn)
7718 rtx dead_insn, current_insn;
7719 {
7720 rtx set = single_set (dead_insn);
7721 rtx set2, dst, prev, next;
7722 if (set)
7723 {
7724 rtx dst = SET_DEST (set);
7725 if (GET_CODE (dst) == MEM)
7726 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XEXP (dst, 0), current_insn);
7727 }
7728 /* If we deleted the store from a reloaded post_{in,de}c expression,
7729 we can delete the matching adds. */
7730 prev = PREV_INSN (dead_insn);
7731 next = NEXT_INSN (dead_insn);
7732 if (! prev || ! next)
7733 return;
7734 set = single_set (next);
7735 set2 = single_set (prev);
7736 if (! set || ! set2
7737 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) != PLUS || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set2)) != PLUS
7738 || GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1)) != CONST_INT
7739 || GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 1)) != CONST_INT)
7740 return;
7741 dst = SET_DEST (set);
7742 if (! rtx_equal_p (dst, SET_DEST (set2))
7743 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0))
7744 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 0))
7745 || (INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1))
7746 != -INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 1))))
7747 return;
7748 delete_insn (prev);
7749 delete_insn (next);
7750 }
7751
7752 /* Subfunction of delete_address_reloads: process registers found in X. */
7753 static void
7754 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, x, current_insn)
7755 rtx dead_insn, x, current_insn;
7756 {
7757 rtx prev, set, dst, i2;
7758 int i, j;
7759 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
7760
7761 if (code != REG)
7762 {
7763 const char *fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
7764 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
7765 {
7766 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
7767 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XEXP (x, i), current_insn);
7768 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
7769 {
7770 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
7771 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XVECEXP (x, i, j),
7772 current_insn);
7773 }
7774 }
7775 return;
7776 }
7777
7778 if (spill_reg_order[REGNO (x)] < 0)
7779 return;
7780
7781 /* Scan backwards for the insn that sets x. This might be a way back due
7782 to inheritance. */
7783 for (prev = PREV_INSN (dead_insn); prev; prev = PREV_INSN (prev))
7784 {
7785 code = GET_CODE (prev);
7786 if (code == CODE_LABEL || code == JUMP_INSN)
7787 return;
7788 if (GET_RTX_CLASS (code) != 'i')
7789 continue;
7790 if (reg_set_p (x, PATTERN (prev)))
7791 break;
7792 if (reg_referenced_p (x, PATTERN (prev)))
7793 return;
7794 }
7795 if (! prev || INSN_UID (prev) < reload_first_uid)
7796 return;
7797 /* Check that PREV only sets the reload register. */
7798 set = single_set (prev);
7799 if (! set)
7800 return;
7801 dst = SET_DEST (set);
7802 if (GET_CODE (dst) != REG
7803 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, x))
7804 return;
7805 if (! reg_set_p (dst, PATTERN (dead_insn)))
7806 {
7807 /* Check if DST was used in a later insn -
7808 it might have been inherited. */
7809 for (i2 = NEXT_INSN (dead_insn); i2; i2 = NEXT_INSN (i2))
7810 {
7811 if (GET_CODE (i2) == CODE_LABEL)
7812 break;
7813 if (! INSN_P (i2))
7814 continue;
7815 if (reg_referenced_p (dst, PATTERN (i2)))
7816 {
7817 /* If there is a reference to the register in the current insn,
7818 it might be loaded in a non-inherited reload. If no other
7819 reload uses it, that means the register is set before
7820 referenced. */
7821 if (i2 == current_insn)
7822 {
7823 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
7824 if ((rld[j].reg_rtx == dst && reload_inherited[j])
7825 || reload_override_in[j] == dst)
7826 return;
7827 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
7828 if (rld[j].in && rld[j].reg_rtx == dst)
7829 break;
7830 if (j >= 0)
7831 break;
7832 }
7833 return;
7834 }
7835 if (GET_CODE (i2) == JUMP_INSN)
7836 break;
7837 /* If DST is still live at CURRENT_INSN, check if it is used for
7838 any reload. Note that even if CURRENT_INSN sets DST, we still
7839 have to check the reloads. */
7840 if (i2 == current_insn)
7841 {
7842 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
7843 if ((rld[j].reg_rtx == dst && reload_inherited[j])
7844 || reload_override_in[j] == dst)
7845 return;
7846 /* ??? We can't finish the loop here, because dst might be
7847 allocated to a pseudo in this block if no reload in this
7848 block needs any of the clsses containing DST - see
7849 spill_hard_reg. There is no easy way to tell this, so we
7850 have to scan till the end of the basic block. */
7851 }
7852 if (reg_set_p (dst, PATTERN (i2)))
7853 break;
7854 }
7855 }
7856 delete_address_reloads_1 (prev, SET_SRC (set), current_insn);
7857 reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (dst)] = -1;
7858 /* Can't use delete_insn here because PREV might be a basic block head. */
7859 PUT_CODE (prev, NOTE);
7860 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (prev) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
7861 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (prev) = 0;
7862 }
7863 \f
7864 /* Output reload-insns to reload VALUE into RELOADREG.
7865 VALUE is an autoincrement or autodecrement RTX whose operand
7866 is a register or memory location;
7867 so reloading involves incrementing that location.
7868 IN is either identical to VALUE, or some cheaper place to reload from.
7869
7870 INC_AMOUNT is the number to increment or decrement by (always positive).
7871 This cannot be deduced from VALUE.
7872
7873 Return the instruction that stores into RELOADREG. */
7874
7875 static rtx
7876 inc_for_reload (reloadreg, in, value, inc_amount)
7877 rtx reloadreg;
7878 rtx in, value;
7879 int inc_amount;
7880 {
7881 /* REG or MEM to be copied and incremented. */
7882 rtx incloc = XEXP (value, 0);
7883 /* Nonzero if increment after copying. */
7884 int post = (GET_CODE (value) == POST_DEC || GET_CODE (value) == POST_INC);
7885 rtx last;
7886 rtx inc;
7887 rtx add_insn;
7888 int code;
7889 rtx store;
7890 rtx real_in = in == value ? XEXP (in, 0) : in;
7891
7892 /* No hard register is equivalent to this register after
7893 inc/dec operation. If REG_LAST_RELOAD_REG were non-zero,
7894 we could inc/dec that register as well (maybe even using it for
7895 the source), but I'm not sure it's worth worrying about. */
7896 if (GET_CODE (incloc) == REG)
7897 reg_last_reload_reg[REGNO (incloc)] = 0;
7898
7899 if (GET_CODE (value) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (value) == POST_DEC)
7900 inc_amount = -inc_amount;
7901
7902 inc = GEN_INT (inc_amount);
7903
7904 /* If this is post-increment, first copy the location to the reload reg. */
7905 if (post && real_in != reloadreg)
7906 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, real_in));
7907
7908 if (in == value)
7909 {
7910 /* See if we can directly increment INCLOC. Use a method similar to
7911 that in gen_reload. */
7912
7913 last = get_last_insn ();
7914 add_insn = emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, incloc,
7915 gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (incloc),
7916 incloc, inc)));
7917
7918 code = recog_memoized (add_insn);
7919 if (code >= 0)
7920 {
7921 extract_insn (add_insn);
7922 if (constrain_operands (1))
7923 {
7924 /* If this is a pre-increment and we have incremented the value
7925 where it lives, copy the incremented value to RELOADREG to
7926 be used as an address. */
7927
7928 if (! post)
7929 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, incloc));
7930
7931 return add_insn;
7932 }
7933 }
7934 delete_insns_since (last);
7935 }
7936
7937 /* If couldn't do the increment directly, must increment in RELOADREG.
7938 The way we do this depends on whether this is pre- or post-increment.
7939 For pre-increment, copy INCLOC to the reload register, increment it
7940 there, then save back. */
7941
7942 if (! post)
7943 {
7944 if (in != reloadreg)
7945 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, real_in));
7946 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
7947 store = emit_insn (gen_move_insn (incloc, reloadreg));
7948 }
7949 else
7950 {
7951 /* Postincrement.
7952 Because this might be a jump insn or a compare, and because RELOADREG
7953 may not be available after the insn in an input reload, we must do
7954 the incrementation before the insn being reloaded for.
7955
7956 We have already copied IN to RELOADREG. Increment the copy in
7957 RELOADREG, save that back, then decrement RELOADREG so it has
7958 the original value. */
7959
7960 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
7961 store = emit_insn (gen_move_insn (incloc, reloadreg));
7962 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, GEN_INT (-inc_amount)));
7963 }
7964
7965 return store;
7966 }
7967 \f
7968 /* Return 1 if we are certain that the constraint-string STRING allows
7969 the hard register REG. Return 0 if we can't be sure of this. */
7970
7971 static int
7972 constraint_accepts_reg_p (string, reg)
7973 const char *string;
7974 rtx reg;
7975 {
7976 int value = 0;
7977 int regno = true_regnum (reg);
7978 int c;
7979
7980 /* Initialize for first alternative. */
7981 value = 0;
7982 /* Check that each alternative contains `g' or `r'. */
7983 while (1)
7984 switch (c = *string++)
7985 {
7986 case 0:
7987 /* If an alternative lacks `g' or `r', we lose. */
7988 return value;
7989 case ',':
7990 /* If an alternative lacks `g' or `r', we lose. */
7991 if (value == 0)
7992 return 0;
7993 /* Initialize for next alternative. */
7994 value = 0;
7995 break;
7996 case 'g':
7997 case 'r':
7998 /* Any general reg wins for this alternative. */
7999 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) GENERAL_REGS], regno))
8000 value = 1;
8001 break;
8002 default:
8003 /* Any reg in specified class wins for this alternative. */
8004 {
8005 enum reg_class class = REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (c);
8006
8007 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) class], regno))
8008 value = 1;
8009 }
8010 }
8011 }
8012 \f
8013 /* INSN is a no-op; delete it.
8014 If this sets the return value of the function, we must keep a USE around,
8015 in case this is in a different basic block than the final USE. Otherwise,
8016 we could loose important register lifeness information on
8017 SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES machines, where return registers might be used as
8018 spills: subsequent passes assume that spill registers are dead at the end
8019 of a basic block.
8020 VALUE must be the return value in such a case, NULL otherwise. */
8021 static void
8022 reload_cse_delete_noop_set (insn, value)
8023 rtx insn, value;
8024 {
8025 if (value)
8026 {
8027 PATTERN (insn) = gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, value);
8028 INSN_CODE (insn) = -1;
8029 REG_NOTES (insn) = NULL_RTX;
8030 }
8031 else
8032 {
8033 PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
8034 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
8035 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
8036 }
8037 }
8038
8039 /* See whether a single set SET is a noop. */
8040 static int
8041 reload_cse_noop_set_p (set)
8042 rtx set;
8043 {
8044 return rtx_equal_for_cselib_p (SET_DEST (set), SET_SRC (set));
8045 }
8046
8047 /* Try to simplify INSN. */
8048 static void
8049 reload_cse_simplify (insn)
8050 rtx insn;
8051 {
8052 rtx body = PATTERN (insn);
8053
8054 if (GET_CODE (body) == SET)
8055 {
8056 int count = 0;
8057
8058 /* Simplify even if we may think it is a no-op.
8059 We may think a memory load of a value smaller than WORD_SIZE
8060 is redundant because we haven't taken into account possible
8061 implicit extension. reload_cse_simplify_set() will bring
8062 this out, so it's safer to simplify before we delete. */
8063 count += reload_cse_simplify_set (body, insn);
8064
8065 if (!count && reload_cse_noop_set_p (body))
8066 {
8067 rtx value = SET_DEST (body);
8068 if (! REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (SET_DEST (body)))
8069 value = 0;
8070 reload_cse_delete_noop_set (insn, value);
8071 return;
8072 }
8073
8074 if (count > 0)
8075 apply_change_group ();
8076 else
8077 reload_cse_simplify_operands (insn);
8078 }
8079 else if (GET_CODE (body) == PARALLEL)
8080 {
8081 int i;
8082 int count = 0;
8083 rtx value = NULL_RTX;
8084
8085 /* If every action in a PARALLEL is a noop, we can delete
8086 the entire PARALLEL. */
8087 for (i = XVECLEN (body, 0) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
8088 {
8089 rtx part = XVECEXP (body, 0, i);
8090 if (GET_CODE (part) == SET)
8091 {
8092 if (! reload_cse_noop_set_p (part))
8093 break;
8094 if (REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (SET_DEST (part)))
8095 {
8096 if (value)
8097 break;
8098 value = SET_DEST (part);
8099 }
8100 }
8101 else if (GET_CODE (part) != CLOBBER)
8102 break;
8103 }
8104
8105 if (i < 0)
8106 {
8107 reload_cse_delete_noop_set (insn, value);
8108 /* We're done with this insn. */
8109 return;
8110 }
8111
8112 /* It's not a no-op, but we can try to simplify it. */
8113 for (i = XVECLEN (body, 0) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
8114 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (body, 0, i)) == SET)
8115 count += reload_cse_simplify_set (XVECEXP (body, 0, i), insn);
8116
8117 if (count > 0)
8118 apply_change_group ();
8119 else
8120 reload_cse_simplify_operands (insn);
8121 }
8122 }
8123
8124 /* Do a very simple CSE pass over the hard registers.
8125
8126 This function detects no-op moves where we happened to assign two
8127 different pseudo-registers to the same hard register, and then
8128 copied one to the other. Reload will generate a useless
8129 instruction copying a register to itself.
8130
8131 This function also detects cases where we load a value from memory
8132 into two different registers, and (if memory is more expensive than
8133 registers) changes it to simply copy the first register into the
8134 second register.
8135
8136 Another optimization is performed that scans the operands of each
8137 instruction to see whether the value is already available in a
8138 hard register. It then replaces the operand with the hard register
8139 if possible, much like an optional reload would. */
8140
8141 static void
8142 reload_cse_regs_1 (first)
8143 rtx first;
8144 {
8145 rtx insn;
8146
8147 cselib_init ();
8148 init_alias_analysis ();
8149
8150 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
8151 {
8152 if (INSN_P (insn))
8153 reload_cse_simplify (insn);
8154
8155 cselib_process_insn (insn);
8156 }
8157
8158 /* Clean up. */
8159 end_alias_analysis ();
8160 cselib_finish ();
8161 }
8162
8163 /* Call cse / combine like post-reload optimization phases.
8164 FIRST is the first instruction. */
8165 void
8166 reload_cse_regs (first)
8167 rtx first;
8168 {
8169 reload_cse_regs_1 (first);
8170 reload_combine ();
8171 reload_cse_move2add (first);
8172 if (flag_expensive_optimizations)
8173 reload_cse_regs_1 (first);
8174 }
8175
8176 /* Try to simplify a single SET instruction. SET is the set pattern.
8177 INSN is the instruction it came from.
8178 This function only handles one case: if we set a register to a value
8179 which is not a register, we try to find that value in some other register
8180 and change the set into a register copy. */
8181
8182 static int
8183 reload_cse_simplify_set (set, insn)
8184 rtx set;
8185 rtx insn;
8186 {
8187 int did_change = 0;
8188 int dreg;
8189 rtx src;
8190 enum reg_class dclass;
8191 int old_cost;
8192 cselib_val *val;
8193 struct elt_loc_list *l;
8194 #ifdef LOAD_EXTEND_OP
8195 enum rtx_code extend_op = NIL;
8196 #endif
8197
8198 dreg = true_regnum (SET_DEST (set));
8199 if (dreg < 0)
8200 return 0;
8201
8202 src = SET_SRC (set);
8203 if (side_effects_p (src) || true_regnum (src) >= 0)
8204 return 0;
8205
8206 dclass = REGNO_REG_CLASS (dreg);
8207
8208 #ifdef LOAD_EXTEND_OP
8209 /* When replacing a memory with a register, we need to honor assumptions
8210 that combine made wrt the contents of sign bits. We'll do this by
8211 generating an extend instruction instead of a reg->reg copy. Thus
8212 the destination must be a register that we can widen. */
8213 if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM
8214 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (src)) < BITS_PER_WORD
8215 && (extend_op = LOAD_EXTEND_OP (GET_MODE (src))) != NIL
8216 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) != REG)
8217 return 0;
8218 #endif
8219
8220 /* If memory loads are cheaper than register copies, don't change them. */
8221 if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
8222 old_cost = MEMORY_MOVE_COST (GET_MODE (src), dclass, 1);
8223 else if (CONSTANT_P (src))
8224 old_cost = rtx_cost (src, SET);
8225 else if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
8226 old_cost = REGISTER_MOVE_COST (GET_MODE (src),
8227 REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (src)), dclass);
8228 else
8229 /* ??? */
8230 old_cost = rtx_cost (src, SET);
8231
8232 val = cselib_lookup (src, GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)), 0);
8233 if (! val)
8234 return 0;
8235 for (l = val->locs; l; l = l->next)
8236 {
8237 rtx this_rtx = l->loc;
8238 int this_cost;
8239
8240 if (CONSTANT_P (this_rtx) && ! references_value_p (this_rtx, 0))
8241 {
8242 #ifdef LOAD_EXTEND_OP
8243 if (extend_op != NIL)
8244 {
8245 HOST_WIDE_INT this_val;
8246
8247 /* ??? I'm lazy and don't wish to handle CONST_DOUBLE. Other
8248 constants, such as SYMBOL_REF, cannot be extended. */
8249 if (GET_CODE (this_rtx) != CONST_INT)
8250 continue;
8251
8252 this_val = INTVAL (this_rtx);
8253 switch (extend_op)
8254 {
8255 case ZERO_EXTEND:
8256 this_val &= GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (src));
8257 break;
8258 case SIGN_EXTEND:
8259 /* ??? In theory we're already extended. */
8260 if (this_val == trunc_int_for_mode (this_val, GET_MODE (src)))
8261 break;
8262 default:
8263 abort ();
8264 }
8265 this_rtx = GEN_INT (this_val);
8266 }
8267 #endif
8268 this_cost = rtx_cost (this_rtx, SET);
8269 }
8270 else if (GET_CODE (this_rtx) == REG)
8271 {
8272 #ifdef LOAD_EXTEND_OP
8273 if (extend_op != NIL)
8274 {
8275 this_rtx = gen_rtx_fmt_e (extend_op, word_mode, this_rtx);
8276 this_cost = rtx_cost (this_rtx, SET);
8277 }
8278 else
8279 #endif
8280 this_cost = REGISTER_MOVE_COST (GET_MODE (this_rtx),
8281 REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (this_rtx)),
8282 dclass);
8283 }
8284 else
8285 continue;
8286
8287 /* If equal costs, prefer registers over anything else. That
8288 tends to lead to smaller instructions on some machines. */
8289 if (this_cost < old_cost
8290 || (this_cost == old_cost
8291 && GET_CODE (this_rtx) == REG
8292 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) != REG))
8293 {
8294 #ifdef LOAD_EXTEND_OP
8295 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set))) < BITS_PER_WORD
8296 && extend_op != NIL)
8297 {
8298 rtx wide_dest = gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, REGNO (SET_DEST (set)));
8299 ORIGINAL_REGNO (wide_dest) = ORIGINAL_REGNO (SET_DEST (set));
8300 validate_change (insn, &SET_DEST (set), wide_dest, 1);
8301 }
8302 #endif
8303
8304 validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (set), copy_rtx (this_rtx), 1);
8305 old_cost = this_cost, did_change = 1;
8306 }
8307 }
8308
8309 return did_change;
8310 }
8311
8312 /* Try to replace operands in INSN with equivalent values that are already
8313 in registers. This can be viewed as optional reloading.
8314
8315 For each non-register operand in the insn, see if any hard regs are
8316 known to be equivalent to that operand. Record the alternatives which
8317 can accept these hard registers. Among all alternatives, select the
8318 ones which are better or equal to the one currently matching, where
8319 "better" is in terms of '?' and '!' constraints. Among the remaining
8320 alternatives, select the one which replaces most operands with
8321 hard registers. */
8322
8323 static int
8324 reload_cse_simplify_operands (insn)
8325 rtx insn;
8326 {
8327 int i, j;
8328
8329 /* For each operand, all registers that are equivalent to it. */
8330 HARD_REG_SET equiv_regs[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
8331
8332 const char *constraints[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
8333
8334 /* Vector recording how bad an alternative is. */
8335 int *alternative_reject;
8336 /* Vector recording how many registers can be introduced by choosing
8337 this alternative. */
8338 int *alternative_nregs;
8339 /* Array of vectors recording, for each operand and each alternative,
8340 which hard register to substitute, or -1 if the operand should be
8341 left as it is. */
8342 int *op_alt_regno[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
8343 /* Array of alternatives, sorted in order of decreasing desirability. */
8344 int *alternative_order;
8345 rtx reg = gen_rtx_REG (VOIDmode, -1);
8346
8347 extract_insn (insn);
8348
8349 if (recog_data.n_alternatives == 0 || recog_data.n_operands == 0)
8350 return 0;
8351
8352 /* Figure out which alternative currently matches. */
8353 if (! constrain_operands (1))
8354 fatal_insn_not_found (insn);
8355
8356 alternative_reject = (int *) alloca (recog_data.n_alternatives * sizeof (int));
8357 alternative_nregs = (int *) alloca (recog_data.n_alternatives * sizeof (int));
8358 alternative_order = (int *) alloca (recog_data.n_alternatives * sizeof (int));
8359 memset ((char *)alternative_reject, 0, recog_data.n_alternatives * sizeof (int));
8360 memset ((char *)alternative_nregs, 0, recog_data.n_alternatives * sizeof (int));
8361
8362 /* For each operand, find out which regs are equivalent. */
8363 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
8364 {
8365 cselib_val *v;
8366 struct elt_loc_list *l;
8367
8368 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (equiv_regs[i]);
8369
8370 /* cselib blows up on CODE_LABELs. Trying to fix that doesn't seem
8371 right, so avoid the problem here. Likewise if we have a constant
8372 and the insn pattern doesn't tell us the mode we need. */
8373 if (GET_CODE (recog_data.operand[i]) == CODE_LABEL
8374 || (CONSTANT_P (recog_data.operand[i])
8375 && recog_data.operand_mode[i] == VOIDmode))
8376 continue;
8377
8378 v = cselib_lookup (recog_data.operand[i], recog_data.operand_mode[i], 0);
8379 if (! v)
8380 continue;
8381
8382 for (l = v->locs; l; l = l->next)
8383 if (GET_CODE (l->loc) == REG)
8384 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (equiv_regs[i], REGNO (l->loc));
8385 }
8386
8387 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
8388 {
8389 enum machine_mode mode;
8390 int regno;
8391 const char *p;
8392
8393 op_alt_regno[i] = (int *) alloca (recog_data.n_alternatives * sizeof (int));
8394 for (j = 0; j < recog_data.n_alternatives; j++)
8395 op_alt_regno[i][j] = -1;
8396
8397 p = constraints[i] = recog_data.constraints[i];
8398 mode = recog_data.operand_mode[i];
8399
8400 /* Add the reject values for each alternative given by the constraints
8401 for this operand. */
8402 j = 0;
8403 while (*p != '\0')
8404 {
8405 char c = *p++;
8406 if (c == ',')
8407 j++;
8408 else if (c == '?')
8409 alternative_reject[j] += 3;
8410 else if (c == '!')
8411 alternative_reject[j] += 300;
8412 }
8413
8414 /* We won't change operands which are already registers. We
8415 also don't want to modify output operands. */
8416 regno = true_regnum (recog_data.operand[i]);
8417 if (regno >= 0
8418 || constraints[i][0] == '='
8419 || constraints[i][0] == '+')
8420 continue;
8421
8422 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; regno++)
8423 {
8424 int class = (int) NO_REGS;
8425
8426 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (equiv_regs[i], regno))
8427 continue;
8428
8429 REGNO (reg) = regno;
8430 PUT_MODE (reg, mode);
8431
8432 /* We found a register equal to this operand. Now look for all
8433 alternatives that can accept this register and have not been
8434 assigned a register they can use yet. */
8435 j = 0;
8436 p = constraints[i];
8437 for (;;)
8438 {
8439 char c = *p++;
8440
8441 switch (c)
8442 {
8443 case '=': case '+': case '?':
8444 case '#': case '&': case '!':
8445 case '*': case '%':
8446 case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4':
8447 case '5': case '6': case '7': case '8': case '9':
8448 case 'm': case '<': case '>': case 'V': case 'o':
8449 case 'E': case 'F': case 'G': case 'H':
8450 case 's': case 'i': case 'n':
8451 case 'I': case 'J': case 'K': case 'L':
8452 case 'M': case 'N': case 'O': case 'P':
8453 case 'p': case 'X':
8454 /* These don't say anything we care about. */
8455 break;
8456
8457 case 'g': case 'r':
8458 class = reg_class_subunion[(int) class][(int) GENERAL_REGS];
8459 break;
8460
8461 default:
8462 class
8463 = reg_class_subunion[(int) class][(int) REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER ((unsigned char)c)];
8464 break;
8465
8466 case ',': case '\0':
8467 /* See if REGNO fits this alternative, and set it up as the
8468 replacement register if we don't have one for this
8469 alternative yet and the operand being replaced is not
8470 a cheap CONST_INT. */
8471 if (op_alt_regno[i][j] == -1
8472 && reg_fits_class_p (reg, class, 0, mode)
8473 && (GET_CODE (recog_data.operand[i]) != CONST_INT
8474 || (rtx_cost (recog_data.operand[i], SET)
8475 > rtx_cost (reg, SET))))
8476 {
8477 alternative_nregs[j]++;
8478 op_alt_regno[i][j] = regno;
8479 }
8480 j++;
8481 break;
8482 }
8483
8484 if (c == '\0')
8485 break;
8486 }
8487 }
8488 }
8489
8490 /* Record all alternatives which are better or equal to the currently
8491 matching one in the alternative_order array. */
8492 for (i = j = 0; i < recog_data.n_alternatives; i++)
8493 if (alternative_reject[i] <= alternative_reject[which_alternative])
8494 alternative_order[j++] = i;
8495 recog_data.n_alternatives = j;
8496
8497 /* Sort it. Given a small number of alternatives, a dumb algorithm
8498 won't hurt too much. */
8499 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_alternatives - 1; i++)
8500 {
8501 int best = i;
8502 int best_reject = alternative_reject[alternative_order[i]];
8503 int best_nregs = alternative_nregs[alternative_order[i]];
8504 int tmp;
8505
8506 for (j = i + 1; j < recog_data.n_alternatives; j++)
8507 {
8508 int this_reject = alternative_reject[alternative_order[j]];
8509 int this_nregs = alternative_nregs[alternative_order[j]];
8510
8511 if (this_reject < best_reject
8512 || (this_reject == best_reject && this_nregs < best_nregs))
8513 {
8514 best = j;
8515 best_reject = this_reject;
8516 best_nregs = this_nregs;
8517 }
8518 }
8519
8520 tmp = alternative_order[best];
8521 alternative_order[best] = alternative_order[i];
8522 alternative_order[i] = tmp;
8523 }
8524
8525 /* Substitute the operands as determined by op_alt_regno for the best
8526 alternative. */
8527 j = alternative_order[0];
8528
8529 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
8530 {
8531 enum machine_mode mode = recog_data.operand_mode[i];
8532 if (op_alt_regno[i][j] == -1)
8533 continue;
8534
8535 validate_change (insn, recog_data.operand_loc[i],
8536 gen_rtx_REG (mode, op_alt_regno[i][j]), 1);
8537 }
8538
8539 for (i = recog_data.n_dups - 1; i >= 0; i--)
8540 {
8541 int op = recog_data.dup_num[i];
8542 enum machine_mode mode = recog_data.operand_mode[op];
8543
8544 if (op_alt_regno[op][j] == -1)
8545 continue;
8546
8547 validate_change (insn, recog_data.dup_loc[i],
8548 gen_rtx_REG (mode, op_alt_regno[op][j]), 1);
8549 }
8550
8551 return apply_change_group ();
8552 }
8553 \f
8554 /* If reload couldn't use reg+reg+offset addressing, try to use reg+reg
8555 addressing now.
8556 This code might also be useful when reload gave up on reg+reg addresssing
8557 because of clashes between the return register and INDEX_REG_CLASS. */
8558
8559 /* The maximum number of uses of a register we can keep track of to
8560 replace them with reg+reg addressing. */
8561 #define RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES 6
8562
8563 /* INSN is the insn where a register has ben used, and USEP points to the
8564 location of the register within the rtl. */
8565 struct reg_use { rtx insn, *usep; };
8566
8567 /* If the register is used in some unknown fashion, USE_INDEX is negative.
8568 If it is dead, USE_INDEX is RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES, and STORE_RUID
8569 indicates where it becomes live again.
8570 Otherwise, USE_INDEX is the index of the last encountered use of the
8571 register (which is first among these we have seen since we scan backwards),
8572 OFFSET contains the constant offset that is added to the register in
8573 all encountered uses, and USE_RUID indicates the first encountered, i.e.
8574 last, of these uses.
8575 STORE_RUID is always meaningful if we only want to use a value in a
8576 register in a different place: it denotes the next insn in the insn
8577 stream (i.e. the last ecountered) that sets or clobbers the register. */
8578 static struct
8579 {
8580 struct reg_use reg_use[RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES];
8581 int use_index;
8582 rtx offset;
8583 int store_ruid;
8584 int use_ruid;
8585 } reg_state[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
8586
8587 /* Reverse linear uid. This is increased in reload_combine while scanning
8588 the instructions from last to first. It is used to set last_label_ruid
8589 and the store_ruid / use_ruid fields in reg_state. */
8590 static int reload_combine_ruid;
8591
8592 #define LABEL_LIVE(LABEL) \
8593 (label_live[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (LABEL) - min_labelno])
8594
8595 static void
8596 reload_combine ()
8597 {
8598 rtx insn, set;
8599 int first_index_reg = -1, last_index_reg;
8600 int i;
8601 unsigned int r;
8602 int last_label_ruid;
8603 int min_labelno, n_labels;
8604 HARD_REG_SET ever_live_at_start, *label_live;
8605
8606 /* If reg+reg can be used in offsetable memory adresses, the main chunk of
8607 reload has already used it where appropriate, so there is no use in
8608 trying to generate it now. */
8609 if (double_reg_address_ok && INDEX_REG_CLASS != NO_REGS)
8610 return;
8611
8612 /* To avoid wasting too much time later searching for an index register,
8613 determine the minimum and maximum index register numbers. */
8614 for (r = 0; r < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; r++)
8615 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[INDEX_REG_CLASS], r))
8616 {
8617 if (first_index_reg == -1)
8618 first_index_reg = r;
8619
8620 last_index_reg = r;
8621 }
8622
8623 /* If no index register is available, we can quit now. */
8624 if (first_index_reg == -1)
8625 return;
8626
8627 /* Set up LABEL_LIVE and EVER_LIVE_AT_START. The register lifetime
8628 information is a bit fuzzy immediately after reload, but it's
8629 still good enough to determine which registers are live at a jump
8630 destination. */
8631 min_labelno = get_first_label_num ();
8632 n_labels = max_label_num () - min_labelno;
8633 label_live = (HARD_REG_SET *) xmalloc (n_labels * sizeof (HARD_REG_SET));
8634 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (ever_live_at_start);
8635
8636 for (i = n_basic_blocks - 1; i >= 0; i--)
8637 {
8638 insn = BLOCK_HEAD (i);
8639 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL)
8640 {
8641 HARD_REG_SET live;
8642
8643 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (live,
8644 BASIC_BLOCK (i)->global_live_at_start);
8645 compute_use_by_pseudos (&live,
8646 BASIC_BLOCK (i)->global_live_at_start);
8647 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (LABEL_LIVE (insn), live);
8648 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (ever_live_at_start, live);
8649 }
8650 }
8651
8652 /* Initialize last_label_ruid, reload_combine_ruid and reg_state. */
8653 last_label_ruid = reload_combine_ruid = 0;
8654 for (r = 0; r < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; r++)
8655 {
8656 reg_state[r].store_ruid = reload_combine_ruid;
8657 if (fixed_regs[r])
8658 reg_state[r].use_index = -1;
8659 else
8660 reg_state[r].use_index = RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES;
8661 }
8662
8663 for (insn = get_last_insn (); insn; insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
8664 {
8665 rtx note;
8666
8667 /* We cannot do our optimization across labels. Invalidating all the use
8668 information we have would be costly, so we just note where the label
8669 is and then later disable any optimization that would cross it. */
8670 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL)
8671 last_label_ruid = reload_combine_ruid;
8672 else if (GET_CODE (insn) == BARRIER)
8673 for (r = 0; r < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; r++)
8674 if (! fixed_regs[r])
8675 reg_state[r].use_index = RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES;
8676
8677 if (! INSN_P (insn))
8678 continue;
8679
8680 reload_combine_ruid++;
8681
8682 /* Look for (set (REGX) (CONST_INT))
8683 (set (REGX) (PLUS (REGX) (REGY)))
8684 ...
8685 ... (MEM (REGX)) ...
8686 and convert it to
8687 (set (REGZ) (CONST_INT))
8688 ...
8689 ... (MEM (PLUS (REGZ) (REGY)))... .
8690
8691 First, check that we have (set (REGX) (PLUS (REGX) (REGY)))
8692 and that we know all uses of REGX before it dies. */
8693 set = single_set (insn);
8694 if (set != NULL_RTX
8695 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == REG
8696 && (HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO (SET_DEST (set)),
8697 GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)))
8698 == 1)
8699 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == PLUS
8700 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1)) == REG
8701 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0), SET_DEST (set))
8702 && last_label_ruid < reg_state[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))].use_ruid)
8703 {
8704 rtx reg = SET_DEST (set);
8705 rtx plus = SET_SRC (set);
8706 rtx base = XEXP (plus, 1);
8707 rtx prev = prev_nonnote_insn (insn);
8708 rtx prev_set = prev ? single_set (prev) : NULL_RTX;
8709 unsigned int regno = REGNO (reg);
8710 rtx const_reg = NULL_RTX;
8711 rtx reg_sum = NULL_RTX;
8712
8713 /* Now, we need an index register.
8714 We'll set index_reg to this index register, const_reg to the
8715 register that is to be loaded with the constant
8716 (denoted as REGZ in the substitution illustration above),
8717 and reg_sum to the register-register that we want to use to
8718 substitute uses of REG (typically in MEMs) with.
8719 First check REG and BASE for being index registers;
8720 we can use them even if they are not dead. */
8721 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[INDEX_REG_CLASS], regno)
8722 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[INDEX_REG_CLASS],
8723 REGNO (base)))
8724 {
8725 const_reg = reg;
8726 reg_sum = plus;
8727 }
8728 else
8729 {
8730 /* Otherwise, look for a free index register. Since we have
8731 checked above that neiter REG nor BASE are index registers,
8732 if we find anything at all, it will be different from these
8733 two registers. */
8734 for (i = first_index_reg; i <= last_index_reg; i++)
8735 {
8736 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[INDEX_REG_CLASS],
8737 i)
8738 && reg_state[i].use_index == RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES
8739 && reg_state[i].store_ruid <= reg_state[regno].use_ruid
8740 && HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i, GET_MODE (reg)) == 1)
8741 {
8742 rtx index_reg = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (reg), i);
8743
8744 const_reg = index_reg;
8745 reg_sum = gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (reg), index_reg, base);
8746 break;
8747 }
8748 }
8749 }
8750
8751 /* Check that PREV_SET is indeed (set (REGX) (CONST_INT)) and that
8752 (REGY), i.e. BASE, is not clobbered before the last use we'll
8753 create. */
8754 if (prev_set != 0
8755 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (prev_set)) == CONST_INT
8756 && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (prev_set), reg)
8757 && reg_state[regno].use_index >= 0
8758 && (reg_state[REGNO (base)].store_ruid
8759 <= reg_state[regno].use_ruid)
8760 && reg_sum != 0)
8761 {
8762 int i;
8763
8764 /* Change destination register and, if necessary, the
8765 constant value in PREV, the constant loading instruction. */
8766 validate_change (prev, &SET_DEST (prev_set), const_reg, 1);
8767 if (reg_state[regno].offset != const0_rtx)
8768 validate_change (prev,
8769 &SET_SRC (prev_set),
8770 GEN_INT (INTVAL (SET_SRC (prev_set))
8771 + INTVAL (reg_state[regno].offset)),
8772 1);
8773
8774 /* Now for every use of REG that we have recorded, replace REG
8775 with REG_SUM. */
8776 for (i = reg_state[regno].use_index;
8777 i < RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES; i++)
8778 validate_change (reg_state[regno].reg_use[i].insn,
8779 reg_state[regno].reg_use[i].usep,
8780 reg_sum, 1);
8781
8782 if (apply_change_group ())
8783 {
8784 rtx *np;
8785
8786 /* Delete the reg-reg addition. */
8787 PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
8788 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
8789 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
8790
8791 if (reg_state[regno].offset != const0_rtx)
8792 /* Previous REG_EQUIV / REG_EQUAL notes for PREV
8793 are now invalid. */
8794 for (np = &REG_NOTES (prev); *np;)
8795 {
8796 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (*np) == REG_EQUAL
8797 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*np) == REG_EQUIV)
8798 *np = XEXP (*np, 1);
8799 else
8800 np = &XEXP (*np, 1);
8801 }
8802
8803 reg_state[regno].use_index = RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES;
8804 reg_state[REGNO (const_reg)].store_ruid
8805 = reload_combine_ruid;
8806 continue;
8807 }
8808 }
8809 }
8810
8811 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), reload_combine_note_store, NULL);
8812
8813 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
8814 {
8815 rtx link;
8816
8817 for (r = 0; r < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; r++)
8818 if (call_used_regs[r])
8819 {
8820 reg_state[r].use_index = RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES;
8821 reg_state[r].store_ruid = reload_combine_ruid;
8822 }
8823
8824 for (link = CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn); link;
8825 link = XEXP (link, 1))
8826 {
8827 rtx usage_rtx = XEXP (XEXP (link, 0), 0);
8828 if (GET_CODE (usage_rtx) == REG)
8829 {
8830 int i;
8831 unsigned int start_reg = REGNO (usage_rtx);
8832 unsigned int num_regs =
8833 HARD_REGNO_NREGS (start_reg, GET_MODE (usage_rtx));
8834 unsigned int end_reg = start_reg + num_regs - 1;
8835 for (i = start_reg; i <= end_reg; i++)
8836 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (link, 0)) == CLOBBER)
8837 {
8838 reg_state[i].use_index = RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES;
8839 reg_state[i].store_ruid = reload_combine_ruid;
8840 }
8841 else
8842 reg_state[i].use_index = -1;
8843 }
8844 }
8845
8846 }
8847 else if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
8848 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != RETURN)
8849 {
8850 /* Non-spill registers might be used at the call destination in
8851 some unknown fashion, so we have to mark the unknown use. */
8852 HARD_REG_SET *live;
8853
8854 if ((condjump_p (insn) || condjump_in_parallel_p (insn))
8855 && JUMP_LABEL (insn))
8856 live = &LABEL_LIVE (JUMP_LABEL (insn));
8857 else
8858 live = &ever_live_at_start;
8859
8860 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER - 1; i >= 0; --i)
8861 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (*live, i))
8862 reg_state[i].use_index = -1;
8863 }
8864
8865 reload_combine_note_use (&PATTERN (insn), insn);
8866 for (note = REG_NOTES (insn); note; note = XEXP (note, 1))
8867 {
8868 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (note) == REG_INC
8869 && GET_CODE (XEXP (note, 0)) == REG)
8870 {
8871 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (note, 0));
8872
8873 reg_state[regno].store_ruid = reload_combine_ruid;
8874 reg_state[regno].use_index = -1;
8875 }
8876 }
8877 }
8878
8879 free (label_live);
8880 }
8881
8882 /* Check if DST is a register or a subreg of a register; if it is,
8883 update reg_state[regno].store_ruid and reg_state[regno].use_index
8884 accordingly. Called via note_stores from reload_combine. */
8885
8886 static void
8887 reload_combine_note_store (dst, set, data)
8888 rtx dst, set;
8889 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
8890 {
8891 int regno = 0;
8892 int i;
8893 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dst);
8894
8895 if (GET_CODE (dst) == SUBREG)
8896 {
8897 regno = subreg_regno_offset (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (dst)),
8898 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (dst)),
8899 SUBREG_BYTE (dst),
8900 GET_MODE (dst));
8901 dst = SUBREG_REG (dst);
8902 }
8903 if (GET_CODE (dst) != REG)
8904 return;
8905 regno += REGNO (dst);
8906
8907 /* note_stores might have stripped a STRICT_LOW_PART, so we have to be
8908 careful with registers / register parts that are not full words.
8909
8910 Similarly for ZERO_EXTRACT and SIGN_EXTRACT. */
8911 if (GET_CODE (set) != SET
8912 || GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == ZERO_EXTRACT
8913 || GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == SIGN_EXTRACT
8914 || GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == STRICT_LOW_PART)
8915 {
8916 for (i = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode) - 1 + regno; i >= regno; i--)
8917 {
8918 reg_state[i].use_index = -1;
8919 reg_state[i].store_ruid = reload_combine_ruid;
8920 }
8921 }
8922 else
8923 {
8924 for (i = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode) - 1 + regno; i >= regno; i--)
8925 {
8926 reg_state[i].store_ruid = reload_combine_ruid;
8927 reg_state[i].use_index = RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES;
8928 }
8929 }
8930 }
8931
8932 /* XP points to a piece of rtl that has to be checked for any uses of
8933 registers.
8934 *XP is the pattern of INSN, or a part of it.
8935 Called from reload_combine, and recursively by itself. */
8936 static void
8937 reload_combine_note_use (xp, insn)
8938 rtx *xp, insn;
8939 {
8940 rtx x = *xp;
8941 enum rtx_code code = x->code;
8942 const char *fmt;
8943 int i, j;
8944 rtx offset = const0_rtx; /* For the REG case below. */
8945
8946 switch (code)
8947 {
8948 case SET:
8949 if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == REG)
8950 {
8951 reload_combine_note_use (&SET_SRC (x), insn);
8952 return;
8953 }
8954 break;
8955
8956 case USE:
8957 /* If this is the USE of a return value, we can't change it. */
8958 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG && REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
8959 {
8960 /* Mark the return register as used in an unknown fashion. */
8961 rtx reg = XEXP (x, 0);
8962 int regno = REGNO (reg);
8963 int nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (reg));
8964
8965 while (--nregs >= 0)
8966 reg_state[regno + nregs].use_index = -1;
8967 return;
8968 }
8969 break;
8970
8971 case CLOBBER:
8972 if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == REG)
8973 return;
8974 break;
8975
8976 case PLUS:
8977 /* We are interested in (plus (reg) (const_int)) . */
8978 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) != REG
8979 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) != CONST_INT)
8980 break;
8981 offset = XEXP (x, 1);
8982 x = XEXP (x, 0);
8983 /* Fall through. */
8984 case REG:
8985 {
8986 int regno = REGNO (x);
8987 int use_index;
8988 int nregs;
8989
8990 /* Some spurious USEs of pseudo registers might remain.
8991 Just ignore them. */
8992 if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8993 return;
8994
8995 nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (x));
8996
8997 /* We can't substitute into multi-hard-reg uses. */
8998 if (nregs > 1)
8999 {
9000 while (--nregs >= 0)
9001 reg_state[regno + nregs].use_index = -1;
9002 return;
9003 }
9004
9005 /* If this register is already used in some unknown fashion, we
9006 can't do anything.
9007 If we decrement the index from zero to -1, we can't store more
9008 uses, so this register becomes used in an unknown fashion. */
9009 use_index = --reg_state[regno].use_index;
9010 if (use_index < 0)
9011 return;
9012
9013 if (use_index != RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES - 1)
9014 {
9015 /* We have found another use for a register that is already
9016 used later. Check if the offsets match; if not, mark the
9017 register as used in an unknown fashion. */
9018 if (! rtx_equal_p (offset, reg_state[regno].offset))
9019 {
9020 reg_state[regno].use_index = -1;
9021 return;
9022 }
9023 }
9024 else
9025 {
9026 /* This is the first use of this register we have seen since we
9027 marked it as dead. */
9028 reg_state[regno].offset = offset;
9029 reg_state[regno].use_ruid = reload_combine_ruid;
9030 }
9031 reg_state[regno].reg_use[use_index].insn = insn;
9032 reg_state[regno].reg_use[use_index].usep = xp;
9033 return;
9034 }
9035
9036 default:
9037 break;
9038 }
9039
9040 /* Recursively process the components of X. */
9041 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
9042 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
9043 {
9044 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
9045 reload_combine_note_use (&XEXP (x, i), insn);
9046 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
9047 {
9048 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
9049 reload_combine_note_use (&XVECEXP (x, i, j), insn);
9050 }
9051 }
9052 }
9053 \f
9054 /* See if we can reduce the cost of a constant by replacing a move
9055 with an add. We track situations in which a register is set to a
9056 constant or to a register plus a constant. */
9057 /* We cannot do our optimization across labels. Invalidating all the
9058 information about register contents we have would be costly, so we
9059 use move2add_last_label_luid to note where the label is and then
9060 later disable any optimization that would cross it.
9061 reg_offset[n] / reg_base_reg[n] / reg_mode[n] are only valid if
9062 reg_set_luid[n] is greater than last_label_luid[n] . */
9063 static int reg_set_luid[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
9064
9065 /* If reg_base_reg[n] is negative, register n has been set to
9066 reg_offset[n] in mode reg_mode[n] .
9067 If reg_base_reg[n] is non-negative, register n has been set to the
9068 sum of reg_offset[n] and the value of register reg_base_reg[n]
9069 before reg_set_luid[n], calculated in mode reg_mode[n] . */
9070 static HOST_WIDE_INT reg_offset[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
9071 static int reg_base_reg[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
9072 static enum machine_mode reg_mode[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
9073
9074 /* move2add_luid is linearily increased while scanning the instructions
9075 from first to last. It is used to set reg_set_luid in
9076 reload_cse_move2add and move2add_note_store. */
9077 static int move2add_luid;
9078
9079 /* move2add_last_label_luid is set whenever a label is found. Labels
9080 invalidate all previously collected reg_offset data. */
9081 static int move2add_last_label_luid;
9082
9083 /* Generate a CONST_INT and force it in the range of MODE. */
9084
9085 static HOST_WIDE_INT
9086 sext_for_mode (mode, value)
9087 enum machine_mode mode;
9088 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
9089 {
9090 HOST_WIDE_INT cval = value & GET_MODE_MASK (mode);
9091 int width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
9092
9093 /* If MODE is narrower than HOST_WIDE_INT and CVAL is a negative number,
9094 sign extend it. */
9095 if (width > 0 && width < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
9096 && (cval & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (width - 1))) != 0)
9097 cval |= (HOST_WIDE_INT) -1 << width;
9098
9099 return cval;
9100 }
9101
9102 /* ??? We don't know how zero / sign extension is handled, hence we
9103 can't go from a narrower to a wider mode. */
9104 #define MODES_OK_FOR_MOVE2ADD(OUTMODE, INMODE) \
9105 (GET_MODE_SIZE (OUTMODE) == GET_MODE_SIZE (INMODE) \
9106 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (OUTMODE) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (INMODE) \
9107 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (OUTMODE), \
9108 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (INMODE))))
9109
9110 static void
9111 reload_cse_move2add (first)
9112 rtx first;
9113 {
9114 int i;
9115 rtx insn;
9116
9117 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER - 1; i >= 0; i--)
9118 reg_set_luid[i] = 0;
9119
9120 move2add_last_label_luid = 0;
9121 move2add_luid = 2;
9122 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn), move2add_luid++)
9123 {
9124 rtx pat, note;
9125
9126 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL)
9127 {
9128 move2add_last_label_luid = move2add_luid;
9129 /* We're going to increment move2add_luid twice after a
9130 label, so that we can use move2add_last_label_luid + 1 as
9131 the luid for constants. */
9132 move2add_luid++;
9133 continue;
9134 }
9135 if (! INSN_P (insn))
9136 continue;
9137 pat = PATTERN (insn);
9138 /* For simplicity, we only perform this optimization on
9139 straightforward SETs. */
9140 if (GET_CODE (pat) == SET
9141 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (pat)) == REG)
9142 {
9143 rtx reg = SET_DEST (pat);
9144 int regno = REGNO (reg);
9145 rtx src = SET_SRC (pat);
9146
9147 /* Check if we have valid information on the contents of this
9148 register in the mode of REG. */
9149 if (reg_set_luid[regno] > move2add_last_label_luid
9150 && MODES_OK_FOR_MOVE2ADD (GET_MODE (reg), reg_mode[regno]))
9151 {
9152 /* Try to transform (set (REGX) (CONST_INT A))
9153 ...
9154 (set (REGX) (CONST_INT B))
9155 to
9156 (set (REGX) (CONST_INT A))
9157 ...
9158 (set (REGX) (plus (REGX) (CONST_INT B-A))) */
9159
9160 if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT && reg_base_reg[regno] < 0)
9161 {
9162 int success = 0;
9163 rtx new_src = GEN_INT (sext_for_mode (GET_MODE (reg),
9164 INTVAL (src)
9165 - reg_offset[regno]));
9166 /* (set (reg) (plus (reg) (const_int 0))) is not canonical;
9167 use (set (reg) (reg)) instead.
9168 We don't delete this insn, nor do we convert it into a
9169 note, to avoid losing register notes or the return
9170 value flag. jump2 already knowns how to get rid of
9171 no-op moves. */
9172 if (new_src == const0_rtx)
9173 success = validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (pat), reg, 0);
9174 else if (rtx_cost (new_src, PLUS) < rtx_cost (src, SET)
9175 && have_add2_insn (GET_MODE (reg)))
9176 success = validate_change (insn, &PATTERN (insn),
9177 gen_add2_insn (reg, new_src), 0);
9178 reg_set_luid[regno] = move2add_luid;
9179 reg_mode[regno] = GET_MODE (reg);
9180 reg_offset[regno] = INTVAL (src);
9181 continue;
9182 }
9183
9184 /* Try to transform (set (REGX) (REGY))
9185 (set (REGX) (PLUS (REGX) (CONST_INT A)))
9186 ...
9187 (set (REGX) (REGY))
9188 (set (REGX) (PLUS (REGX) (CONST_INT B)))
9189 to
9190 (REGX) (REGY))
9191 (set (REGX) (PLUS (REGX) (CONST_INT A)))
9192 ...
9193 (set (REGX) (plus (REGX) (CONST_INT B-A))) */
9194 else if (GET_CODE (src) == REG
9195 && reg_set_luid[regno] == reg_set_luid[REGNO (src)]
9196 && reg_base_reg[regno] == reg_base_reg[REGNO (src)]
9197 && MODES_OK_FOR_MOVE2ADD (GET_MODE (reg),
9198 reg_mode[REGNO (src)]))
9199 {
9200 rtx next = next_nonnote_insn (insn);
9201 rtx set = NULL_RTX;
9202 if (next)
9203 set = single_set (next);
9204 if (set
9205 && SET_DEST (set) == reg
9206 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == PLUS
9207 && XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0) == reg
9208 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1)) == CONST_INT)
9209 {
9210 rtx src3 = XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1);
9211 HOST_WIDE_INT added_offset = INTVAL (src3);
9212 HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset = reg_offset[REGNO (src)];
9213 HOST_WIDE_INT regno_offset = reg_offset[regno];
9214 rtx new_src = GEN_INT (sext_for_mode (GET_MODE (reg),
9215 added_offset
9216 + base_offset
9217 - regno_offset));
9218 int success = 0;
9219
9220 if (new_src == const0_rtx)
9221 /* See above why we create (set (reg) (reg)) here. */
9222 success
9223 = validate_change (next, &SET_SRC (set), reg, 0);
9224 else if ((rtx_cost (new_src, PLUS)
9225 < COSTS_N_INSNS (1) + rtx_cost (src3, SET))
9226 && have_add2_insn (GET_MODE (reg)))
9227 success
9228 = validate_change (next, &PATTERN (next),
9229 gen_add2_insn (reg, new_src), 0);
9230 if (success)
9231 {
9232 /* INSN might be the first insn in a basic block
9233 if the preceding insn is a conditional jump
9234 or a possible-throwing call. */
9235 PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
9236 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
9237 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
9238 }
9239 insn = next;
9240 reg_mode[regno] = GET_MODE (reg);
9241 reg_offset[regno] = sext_for_mode (GET_MODE (reg),
9242 added_offset
9243 + base_offset);
9244 continue;
9245 }
9246 }
9247 }
9248 }
9249
9250 for (note = REG_NOTES (insn); note; note = XEXP (note, 1))
9251 {
9252 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (note) == REG_INC
9253 && GET_CODE (XEXP (note, 0)) == REG)
9254 {
9255 /* Reset the information about this register. */
9256 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (note, 0));
9257 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
9258 reg_set_luid[regno] = 0;
9259 }
9260 }
9261 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), move2add_note_store, NULL);
9262 /* If this is a CALL_INSN, all call used registers are stored with
9263 unknown values. */
9264 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
9265 {
9266 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER - 1; i >= 0; i--)
9267 {
9268 if (call_used_regs[i])
9269 /* Reset the information about this register. */
9270 reg_set_luid[i] = 0;
9271 }
9272 }
9273 }
9274 }
9275
9276 /* SET is a SET or CLOBBER that sets DST.
9277 Update reg_set_luid, reg_offset and reg_base_reg accordingly.
9278 Called from reload_cse_move2add via note_stores. */
9279
9280 static void
9281 move2add_note_store (dst, set, data)
9282 rtx dst, set;
9283 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
9284 {
9285 unsigned int regno = 0;
9286 unsigned int i;
9287 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dst);
9288
9289 if (GET_CODE (dst) == SUBREG)
9290 {
9291 regno = subreg_regno_offset (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (dst)),
9292 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (dst)),
9293 SUBREG_BYTE (dst),
9294 GET_MODE (dst));
9295 dst = SUBREG_REG (dst);
9296 }
9297
9298 /* Some targets do argument pushes without adding REG_INC notes. */
9299
9300 if (GET_CODE (dst) == MEM)
9301 {
9302 dst = XEXP (dst, 0);
9303 if (GET_CODE (dst) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (dst) == POST_DEC
9304 || GET_CODE (dst) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (dst) == POST_DEC)
9305 reg_set_luid[REGNO (XEXP (dst, 0))] = 0;
9306 return;
9307 }
9308 if (GET_CODE (dst) != REG)
9309 return;
9310
9311 regno += REGNO (dst);
9312
9313 if (HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode) == 1 && GET_CODE (set) == SET
9314 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) != ZERO_EXTRACT
9315 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) != SIGN_EXTRACT
9316 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) != STRICT_LOW_PART)
9317 {
9318 rtx src = SET_SRC (set);
9319 rtx base_reg;
9320 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
9321 int base_regno;
9322 /* This may be different from mode, if SET_DEST (set) is a
9323 SUBREG. */
9324 enum machine_mode dst_mode = GET_MODE (dst);
9325
9326 switch (GET_CODE (src))
9327 {
9328 case PLUS:
9329 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == REG)
9330 {
9331 base_reg = XEXP (src, 0);
9332
9333 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
9334 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
9335 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == REG
9336 && (reg_set_luid[REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))]
9337 > move2add_last_label_luid)
9338 && (MODES_OK_FOR_MOVE2ADD
9339 (dst_mode, reg_mode[REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))])))
9340 {
9341 if (reg_base_reg[REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))] < 0)
9342 offset = reg_offset[REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))];
9343 /* Maybe the first register is known to be a
9344 constant. */
9345 else if (reg_set_luid[REGNO (base_reg)]
9346 > move2add_last_label_luid
9347 && (MODES_OK_FOR_MOVE2ADD
9348 (dst_mode, reg_mode[REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))]))
9349 && reg_base_reg[REGNO (base_reg)] < 0)
9350 {
9351 offset = reg_offset[REGNO (base_reg)];
9352 base_reg = XEXP (src, 1);
9353 }
9354 else
9355 goto invalidate;
9356 }
9357 else
9358 goto invalidate;
9359
9360 break;
9361 }
9362
9363 goto invalidate;
9364
9365 case REG:
9366 base_reg = src;
9367 offset = 0;
9368 break;
9369
9370 case CONST_INT:
9371 /* Start tracking the register as a constant. */
9372 reg_base_reg[regno] = -1;
9373 reg_offset[regno] = INTVAL (SET_SRC (set));
9374 /* We assign the same luid to all registers set to constants. */
9375 reg_set_luid[regno] = move2add_last_label_luid + 1;
9376 reg_mode[regno] = mode;
9377 return;
9378
9379 default:
9380 invalidate:
9381 /* Invalidate the contents of the register. */
9382 reg_set_luid[regno] = 0;
9383 return;
9384 }
9385
9386 base_regno = REGNO (base_reg);
9387 /* If information about the base register is not valid, set it
9388 up as a new base register, pretending its value is known
9389 starting from the current insn. */
9390 if (reg_set_luid[base_regno] <= move2add_last_label_luid)
9391 {
9392 reg_base_reg[base_regno] = base_regno;
9393 reg_offset[base_regno] = 0;
9394 reg_set_luid[base_regno] = move2add_luid;
9395 reg_mode[base_regno] = mode;
9396 }
9397 else if (! MODES_OK_FOR_MOVE2ADD (dst_mode,
9398 reg_mode[base_regno]))
9399 goto invalidate;
9400
9401 reg_mode[regno] = mode;
9402
9403 /* Copy base information from our base register. */
9404 reg_set_luid[regno] = reg_set_luid[base_regno];
9405 reg_base_reg[regno] = reg_base_reg[base_regno];
9406
9407 /* Compute the sum of the offsets or constants. */
9408 reg_offset[regno] = sext_for_mode (dst_mode,
9409 offset
9410 + reg_offset[base_regno]);
9411 }
9412 else
9413 {
9414 unsigned int endregno = regno + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode);
9415
9416 for (i = regno; i < endregno; i++)
9417 /* Reset the information about this register. */
9418 reg_set_luid[i] = 0;
9419 }
9420 }
9421
9422 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
9423 static void
9424 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, x)
9425 rtx insn;
9426 rtx x;
9427 {
9428 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
9429 const char *fmt;
9430 int i, j;
9431
9432 if (code == MEM && auto_inc_p (XEXP (x, 0)))
9433 {
9434 REG_NOTES (insn)
9435 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_INC, XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), REG_NOTES (insn));
9436 return;
9437 }
9438
9439 /* Scan all the operand sub-expressions. */
9440 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
9441 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
9442 {
9443 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
9444 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, XEXP (x, i));
9445 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
9446 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
9447 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, XVECEXP (x, i, j));
9448 }
9449 }
9450 #endif
9451
9452 /* Copy EH notes from an insn to its reloads. */
9453 static void
9454 copy_eh_notes (insn, x)
9455 rtx insn;
9456 rtx x;
9457 {
9458 rtx eh_note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_EH_REGION, NULL_RTX);
9459 if (eh_note)
9460 {
9461 for (; x != 0; x = NEXT_INSN (x))
9462 {
9463 if (may_trap_p (PATTERN (x)))
9464 REG_NOTES (x)
9465 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EH_REGION, XEXP (eh_note, 0),
9466 REG_NOTES (x));
9467 }
9468 }
9469 }
9470
This page took 0.484378 seconds and 6 git commands to generate.